blob: 5f4c4b1eeab1e47d5740014dab3393293a5bff93 [file] [log] [blame]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001==============================
2LLVM Language Reference Manual
3==============================
4
5.. contents::
6 :local:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00007 :depth: 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009Abstract
10========
11
12This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
17strategy.
18
19Introduction
20============
21
22The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24(suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30representation and notation.
31
32The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41instead of a memory location.
42
43.. _wellformed:
44
45Well-Formedness
46---------------
47
48It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
52
53.. code-block:: llvm
54
55 %x = add i32 1, %x
56
57because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
63
64.. _identifiers:
65
66Identifiers
67===========
68
69LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73identifiers, for different purposes:
74
75#. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
Sean Silva9d01a5b2015-01-07 21:35:14 +000078 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000079 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
Hans Wennborg85e06532014-07-30 20:02:08 +000082 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global variables to suppress mangling.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000084#. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000086#. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000087
88LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
93conflicts.
94
95Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97'``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98'``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100(``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
101
102Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
103'``%X``' by 8:
104
105The easy way:
106
107.. code-block:: llvm
108
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
110
111After strength reduction:
112
113.. code-block:: llvm
114
Dmitri Gribenko675911d2013-01-26 13:30:13 +0000115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000116
117And the hard way:
118
119.. code-block:: llvm
120
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +0000121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
124
125This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126lexical features of LLVM:
127
128#. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129#. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
Sean Silva8ca11782013-05-20 23:31:12 +0000131#. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000136
137It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139that defines the type and name of value produced.
140
141High Level Structure
142====================
143
144Module Structure
145----------------
146
147LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
153
154.. code-block:: llvm
155
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000158
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000161
162 ; Definition of main function
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *...
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +0000165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000166
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000169 ret i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000170 }
171
172 ; Named metadata
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
Nick Lewyckya0de40a2014-08-13 04:54:05 +0000174 !foo = !{!0}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000175
176This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177"``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178:ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179:ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
180
181In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
186
187.. _linkage:
188
189Linkage Types
190-------------
191
192All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
193linkage:
194
195``private``
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with an private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000202``internal``
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted
208 into the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. They exist to
209 allow inlining and other optimizations to take place given knowledge
210 of the definition of the global, which is known to be somewhere
211 outside the module. Globals with ``available_externally`` linkage
212 are allowed to be discarded at will, and are otherwise the same as
213 ``linkonce_odr``. This linkage type is only allowed on definitions,
214 not declarations.
215``linkonce``
216 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
217 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
218 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
219 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
220 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
221 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
222 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
223 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
224 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
225 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
226 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
227 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
228``weak``
229 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
230 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
231 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
232 in C source code.
233``common``
234 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
235 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
236 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
237 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
238 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
239 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
240 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
241 common linkage.
242
243.. _linkage_appending:
244
245``appending``
246 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
247 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
248 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
249 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
250 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
251 .o files are linked.
252``extern_weak``
253 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
254 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
255 instead of being an undefined reference.
256``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
257 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
258 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
259 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000260 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000261 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
262 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
263 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000264``external``
265 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
266 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
267 resolve external symbol references.
268
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000269It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000270other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000271
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000272.. _callingconv:
273
274Calling Conventions
275-------------------
276
277LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
278:ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
279specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
280caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
281The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
282added in the future:
283
284"``ccc``" - The C calling convention
285 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
286 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
287 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
288 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
289 the function (as does normal C).
290"``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
291 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
292 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
293 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
294 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
295 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
296 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
297 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
298 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
299 match the prototype of the function definition.
300"``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
301 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
302 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
303 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
304 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
305 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
306 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000307 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
308 calls for inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000309"``cc 10``" - GHC convention
310 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
311 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
312 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
313 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
314 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
315 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
316 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
317 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
318 limitations:
319
320 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
321 floating point types are supported.
322 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
323 floating point parameters.
324
325 This calling convention supports `tail call
326 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
327 caller and callee are using it.
328"``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
329 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
330 the `High-Performance Erlang
331 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
332 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
333 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
334 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
335 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
336 convention properly supports `tail call
337 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
338 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
339 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
340 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
341 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
342 bit).
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000343"``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
344 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
345 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
346 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
347 platform's customary return register.
348"``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
349 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
350 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000351 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000352 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
353 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
354 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000355"``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000356 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
357 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000358 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
359 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
360 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000361 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
362 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
363 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000364
365 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
366 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
367 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
368
369 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
370 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000371 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000372 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000373 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
374 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
375 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
376 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
377 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
378 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
379 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000380
381 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
382 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
383 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
384 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
385 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
386 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
387 future.
388"``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
389 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
390 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
391 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
392 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
393 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000394 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
395 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
396 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
397 returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000398
399 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
400 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
401 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
402
403 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
404 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
405
406 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
407 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
408 experimental at this time.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000409"``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000410 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
411 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
412 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
413 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
414 sequence.
415
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000416 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000417 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
418 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
419
420 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
421 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
422 caller/callee-saved registers.
423
424 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
425 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000426
427 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
428 RDI and RAX.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000429"``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
430 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
431 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
432 calling conventions start at 64.
433
434More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
435support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
436convention.
437
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000438.. _visibilitystyles:
439
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000440Visibility Styles
441-----------------
442
443All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
444styles:
445
446"``default``" - Default style
447 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
448 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
449 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
450 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
451 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
452 linkage" in the language.
453"``hidden``" - Hidden style
454 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
455 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
456 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
457 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
458 library) can reference it directly.
459"``protected``" - Protected style
460 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
461 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
462 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
463 cannot be overridden by another module.
464
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithb80de102014-05-07 22:57:20 +0000465A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
466visibility.
467
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000468.. _dllstorageclass:
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000469
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000470DLL Storage Classes
471-------------------
472
473All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
474DLL storage class:
475
476``dllimport``
477 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
478 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
479 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
480 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
481``dllexport``
482 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
483 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
484 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
485 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
486 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
487 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
488
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000489.. _tls_model:
490
491Thread Local Storage Models
492---------------------------
493
494A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
495not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
496variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
497TLS model may be specified:
498
499``localdynamic``
500 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
501``initialexec``
502 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
503``localexec``
504 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
505
506If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
507
508The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
509Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
510more information on under which circumstances the different models may
511be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
512model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
513
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000514A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000515the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
516
Chih-Hung Hsieh1e859582015-07-28 16:24:05 +0000517For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
518flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
519
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000520.. _namedtypes:
521
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000522Structure Types
523---------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000524
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000525LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000526types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
527are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +0000528to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000529
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000530An example of an identified structure specification is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000531
532.. code-block:: llvm
533
534 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
535
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000536Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000537literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000538
539.. _globalvars:
540
541Global Variables
542----------------
543
544Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000545instead of run-time.
546
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000547Global variable definitions must be initialized.
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000548
549Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
550case they don't have an initializer.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000551
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000552Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
553to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified.
554
Michael Gottesman006039c2013-01-31 05:48:48 +0000555A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000556the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
557optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
558section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
Michael Gottesman1cffcf742013-01-31 05:44:04 +0000559initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000560variable.
561
562LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
563constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
564capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
565program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
566optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
567units that do not include the definition.
568
569As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
570(i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
571always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
572region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
573pointers.
574
575Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
576that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
577like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
578initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
579merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
580whose address is significant.
581
582A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
583numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
584may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
585instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
586is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
587
588LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
589target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000590Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
591support.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000592
Michael Gottesmane743a302013-02-04 03:22:00 +0000593By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000594variables defined within the module are not modified from their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000595initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000596true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
597module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
Yunzhong Gaof5b769e2013-12-05 18:37:54 +0000598``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
599by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000600
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000601An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
602power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
603alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
604convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
605to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
606to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
607case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
608assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
609iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +0000610iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000611
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000612Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`.
613
Peter Collingbourne69ba0162015-02-04 00:42:45 +0000614Variables and aliases can have a
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000615:ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
616
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000617Syntax::
618
619 [@<GlobalVarName> =] [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
Rafael Espindola28f3ca62014-06-09 21:21:33 +0000620 [unnamed_addr] [AddrSpace] [ExternallyInitialized]
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000621 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000622 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
623 [, align <Alignment>]
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000624
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000625For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
626with an initializer, section, and alignment:
627
628.. code-block:: llvm
629
630 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
631
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000632The following example just declares a global variable
633
634.. code-block:: llvm
635
636 @G = external global i32
637
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000638The following example defines a thread-local global with the
639``initialexec`` TLS model:
640
641.. code-block:: llvm
642
643 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
644
645.. _functionstructure:
646
647Functions
648---------
649
650LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
651optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000652style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
653an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000654an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
655:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
656name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
657attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000658an optional section, an optional alignment,
659an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000660an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000661an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
662an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +0000663an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000664an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000665
666LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
667optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000668style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
669an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000670an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
671:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +0000672name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000673:ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
674and an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000675
Bill Wendling6822ecb2013-10-27 05:09:12 +0000676A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
677Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
678(giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
679and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
680function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
681implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
682unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
683entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
684then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000685
686The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
687immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
688to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
689the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
690predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
691
692LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
693target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000694Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000695
696An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
697or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
698by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
699is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
700alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
701
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000702If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000703be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
704
705Syntax::
706
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000707 define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000708 [cconv] [ret attrs]
709 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000710 [unnamed_addr] [fn Attrs] [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]]
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000711 [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant] [prologue Constant]
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +0000712 [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000713
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000714The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
715argument is of the following form:
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000716
717Syntax::
718
719 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
720
721
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000722.. _langref_aliases:
723
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000724Aliases
725-------
726
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000727Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
728are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
729
730Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
731constant expression.
732
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000733Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000734:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
735<dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000736
737Syntax::
738
David Blaikie196582e2015-10-22 01:17:29 +0000739 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [unnamed_addr] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000740
Rafael Espindola2fb5bc32014-03-13 23:18:37 +0000741The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
Rafael Espindola716e7402013-11-01 17:09:14 +0000742``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000743might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
Rafael Espindola78527052013-10-06 15:10:43 +0000744
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000745Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
Rafael Espindola42a4c9f2014-06-06 01:20:28 +0000746the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
747to the same content.
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000748
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000749Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
750some can only be checked when producing an object file:
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000751
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000752* The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
753 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
754
755* No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
756 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
757 object file.
758
759* No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
760 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
Rafael Espindola24a669d2014-03-27 15:26:56 +0000761
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000762.. _langref_comdats:
763
764Comdats
765-------
766
767Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
768
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000769Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000770specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000771that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000772aliasee computes to, if any.
773
774Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
775choose between keys in two different object files.
776
777Syntax::
778
779 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
780
781The selection kind must be one of the following:
782
783``any``
784 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
785``exactmatch``
786 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
787 same data.
788``largest``
789 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
790``noduplicates``
791 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
792``samesize``
793 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
794 same amount of data.
795
796Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs and ELF only supports
797``any`` as a selection kind.
798
799Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
800the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
801
802.. code-block:: llvm
803
804 $foo = comdat largest
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000805 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000806
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000807 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000808 ret void
809 }
810
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000811As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
812the global name:
813
814.. code-block:: llvm
815
816 $foo = comdat any
817 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
818
819
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000820In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
821``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
822and another COMDAT section with selection kind
823``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
Hans Wennborg0def0662014-09-10 17:05:08 +0000824section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000825
826There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
827It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
828targeting COFF.
829The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
830which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
831Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
832linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
833if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
834
835The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
836For example:
837
838.. code-block:: llvm
839
840 $foo = comdat any
841 $bar = comdat any
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000842 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
843 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000844
845From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000846with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000847COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
848sections.
849
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000850Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
851create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000852COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000853in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
854is supplied to `llc`).
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000855
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000856.. _namedmetadatastructure:
857
858Named Metadata
859--------------
860
861Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
862nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
863operands for a named metadata.
864
Filipe Cabecinhas62431b12015-06-02 21:25:08 +0000865#. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
866 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
867 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
868 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
869
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000870Syntax::
871
872 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000873 !0 = !{!"zero"}
874 !1 = !{!"one"}
875 !2 = !{!"two"}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000876 ; A named metadata.
877 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
878
879.. _paramattrs:
880
881Parameter Attributes
882--------------------
883
884The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
885*parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
886used to communicate additional information about the result or
887parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
888of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
889parameter attributes can have the same function type.
890
891Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
892If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
893For example:
894
895.. code-block:: llvm
896
897 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
898 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
899 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
900
901Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
902``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
903
904Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
905
906``zeroext``
907 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
908 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
909 ABI (which is usually 32-bits, but is 8-bits for a i1 on x86-64) by
910 the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
911``signext``
912 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
913 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
914 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
915 the callee (for a return value).
916``inreg``
917 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000918 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000919 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
920 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
921 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
922 target-specific.
923``byval``
924 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
925 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
926 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
927 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
928 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
929 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
930 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
931 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
932 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
933 values.
934
935 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
936 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
937 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
938 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
939 makes a target-specific assumption.
940
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000941.. _attr_inalloca:
942
943``inalloca``
944
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000945 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000946 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000947 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
948 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000949 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000950 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000951
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000952 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000953 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000954 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000955 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
Reid Klecknerf5b76512014-01-31 23:50:57 +0000956 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
957 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
958 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000959
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000960 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
961 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000962 results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000963 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
964 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
965 <int_stackrestore>`.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000966
967 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
968 attribute.
969
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000970``sret``
971 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
972 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
973 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
Eli Bendersky4f2162f2013-01-23 22:05:19 +0000974 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000975 not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to
976 the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return
977 values.
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +0000978
Hal Finkelccc70902014-07-22 16:58:55 +0000979``align <n>``
980 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
981 have the specified alignment.
982
983 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
984 ``byval`` attribute.
985
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +0000986.. _noalias:
987
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000988``noalias``
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +0000989 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
990 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
991 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
992 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
993 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
994 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
995 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
996 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000997
998 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +0000999 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001000
1001 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001002 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1003 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1004 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1005 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1006 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1007 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001009``nocapture``
1010 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1011 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
1012 attribute for return values.
1013
1014.. _nest:
1015
1016``nest``
1017 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1018 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
Stephen Linb8bd2322013-04-20 05:14:40 +00001019 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1020
1021``returned``
Stephen Linfec5b0b2013-06-20 21:55:10 +00001022 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
1023 value. This is an optimization hint to the code generator when generating
1024 the caller, allowing tail call optimization and omission of register saves
1025 and restores in some cases; it is not checked or enforced when generating
1026 the callee. The parameter and the function return type must be valid
1027 operands for the :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a
1028 valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001029
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001030``nonnull``
1031 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1032 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1033 checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001034 passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001035 is non-null.
1036
Hal Finkelb0407ba2014-07-18 15:51:28 +00001037``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1038 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1039 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1040 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1041 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1042 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1043 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1044 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1045 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1046 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1047
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001048``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1049 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1050 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001051 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001052 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1053 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1054 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1055 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1056 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1057 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001058 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001059 pointer typed parameters.
1060
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001061.. _gc:
1062
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001063Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1064--------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001065
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001066Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001067string:
1068
1069.. code-block:: llvm
1070
1071 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1072
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001073The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001074<builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001075strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001076named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001077garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001078which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001079
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001080.. _prefixdata:
1081
1082Prefix Data
1083-----------
1084
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001085Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1086generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1087The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1088language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1089available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1090function pointer to be called.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001091
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001092To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1093function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001094index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001095the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1096with a single ``i32``,
1097
1098.. code-block:: llvm
1099
1100 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1101
1102The prefix data can be referenced as,
1103
1104.. code-block:: llvm
1105
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001106 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1107 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00001108 %b = load i32, i32* %a
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001109
1110Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001111of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001112beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1113of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1114function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1115function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1116data.
1117
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001118A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001119to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1120optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1121
1122.. _prologuedata:
1123
1124Prologue Data
1125-------------
1126
1127The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1128be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1129function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1130
1131To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001132have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001133bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1134module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001135the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001136the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001137definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001138makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001139
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001140A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001141which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1142
1143.. code-block:: llvm
1144
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001145 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001146
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001147Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1148which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001149x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1150
1151.. code-block:: llvm
1152
1153 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1154
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001155 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001156
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001157A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001158to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1159optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1160
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001161.. _personalityfn:
1162
1163Personality Function
David Majnemerc5ad8a92015-06-17 21:21:16 +00001164--------------------
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001165
1166The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1167to use for exception handling.
1168
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001169.. _attrgrp:
1170
1171Attribute Groups
1172----------------
1173
1174Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1175the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1176functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1177``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1178group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1179
1180An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1181object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1182to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1183different groups are merged.
1184
1185Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1186inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1187
1188.. code-block:: llvm
1189
1190 ; Target-independent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001191 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001192
1193 ; Target-dependent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001194 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001195
1196 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1197 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1198
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001199.. _fnattrs:
1200
1201Function Attributes
1202-------------------
1203
1204Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1205a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1206function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1207attributes can have the same function type.
1208
1209Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1210If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1211example:
1212
1213.. code-block:: llvm
1214
1215 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1216 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1217 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1218 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1219
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001220``alignstack(<n>)``
1221 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1222 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1223 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1224 parentheses.
1225``alwaysinline``
1226 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1227 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1228 inlining size threshold for this caller.
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001229``builtin``
1230 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1231 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
Michael Gottesman3a6a9672013-07-02 21:32:56 +00001232 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001233 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001234 attribute.
Michael Gottesman296adb82013-06-27 22:48:08 +00001235``cold``
1236 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1237 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1238 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1239 weight.
Owen Anderson85fa7d52015-05-26 23:48:40 +00001240``convergent``
1241 This attribute indicates that the callee is dependent on a convergent
1242 thread execution pattern under certain parallel execution models.
Owen Andersond95b08a2015-10-09 18:06:13 +00001243 Transformations that are execution model agnostic may not make the execution
1244 of a convergent operation control dependent on any additional values.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001245``inlinehint``
1246 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1247 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1248 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1249 inliner.
Tom Roeder44cb65f2014-06-05 19:29:43 +00001250``jumptable``
1251 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1252 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1253 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1254 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1255 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1256 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1257 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001258``minsize``
1259 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1260 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001261 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001262 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001263``naked``
1264 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1265 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001266``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001267 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1268 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1269 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1270 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1271 and on function declarations and definitions.
Bill Wendlingbf902f12013-02-06 06:22:58 +00001272``noduplicate``
1273 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1274 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1275 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1276 its parent function.
1277
1278 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1279 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1280 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1281 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1282 call is dead after inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001283``noimplicitfloat``
1284 This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.
1285``noinline``
1286 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1287 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1288 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
Sean Silva1cbbcf12013-08-06 19:34:37 +00001289``nonlazybind``
1290 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1291 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1292 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001293``noredzone``
1294 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1295 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1296``noreturn``
1297 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1298 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1299 function ever does dynamically return.
James Molloye6f87ca2015-11-06 10:32:53 +00001300``norecurse``
1301 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1302 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1303 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001304``nounwind``
Reid Kleckner96d01132015-02-11 01:23:16 +00001305 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1306 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1307 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1308 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1309 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1310 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001311``optnone``
Paul Robinsona2550a62015-11-30 21:56:16 +00001312 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1313 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1314 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001315 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1316 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1317 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001318
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001319 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1320 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001321 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001322 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001323``optsize``
1324 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1325 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001326 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1327 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001328``readnone``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001329 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1330 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001331 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1332 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1333 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1334 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1335 to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1336 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001337
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001338 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1339 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
Nick Lewyckyefe31f22013-07-06 01:04:47 +00001340 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001341``readonly``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001342 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1343 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001344 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1345 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1346 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1347 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1348 called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot
1349 unwind an exception by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing
1350 methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001351
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001352 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1353 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1354 the pointer points to.
Igor Laevsky39d662f2015-07-11 10:30:36 +00001355``argmemonly``
1356 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1357 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1358 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1359 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1360 arguments.
1361 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1362 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001363``returns_twice``
1364 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1365 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1366 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1367 functions.
Peter Collingbourne82437bf2015-06-15 21:07:11 +00001368``safestack``
1369 This attribute indicates that
1370 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1371 protection is enabled for this function.
1372
1373 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1374 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1375 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1376 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
Kostya Serebryanycf880b92013-02-26 06:58:09 +00001377``sanitize_address``
1378 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1379 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1380``sanitize_memory``
1381 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1382 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1383``sanitize_thread``
1384 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1385 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001386``ssp``
1387 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00001388 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001389 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1390 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1391 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001392 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001393
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001394 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1395 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1396 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1397 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001398
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001399 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1400 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1401
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001402 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1403 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1404 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1405``sspreq``
1406 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1407 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1408 attribute.
1409
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001410 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1411 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1412 The specific layout rules are:
1413
1414 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1415 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1416 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1417 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1418 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1419 protector.
1420
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001421 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1422 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001423 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1424 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1425``sspstrong``
1426 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001427 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001428 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001429 will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001430
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001431 - Arrays of any size and type
1432 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1433 - Calls to alloca().
1434 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1435
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001436 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1437 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1438 The specific layout rules are:
1439
1440 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1441 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1442 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1443 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1444 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1445 protector.
1446
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001447 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001448
1449 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1450 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1451 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
Reid Kleckner5a2ab2b2015-03-04 00:08:56 +00001452``"thunk"``
1453 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1454 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1455 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1456 match the thunk target prototype.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001457``uwtable``
1458 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001459 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001460 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1461 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1462 units.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001463
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001464
1465.. _opbundles:
1466
1467Operand Bundles
1468---------------
1469
1470Note: operand bundles are a work in progress, and they should be
1471considered experimental at this time.
1472
1473Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
Sanjoy Dasb0e9d4a52015-09-25 00:05:40 +00001474with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1475``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001476incorrect and will change program semantics.
1477
1478Syntax::
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001479
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001480 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001481 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1482 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1483 tag ::= string constant
1484
1485Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1486given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1487of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1488are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1489callee being dispatched to.
1490
1491Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1492runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1493the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1494there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1495bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1496are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1497long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1498restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1499operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1500
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001501- The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1502 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1503- Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1504 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
Sanjoy Das98a341b2015-10-22 03:12:22 +00001505 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overriden with
1506 callsite specific attributes.
1507- An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1508 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1509 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001510
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001511More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1512
1513Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1514^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1515
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001516Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001517operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1518"safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1519used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001520specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1521bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1522out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1523rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001524
1525From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1526the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1527through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1528otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1529operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1530deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1531compiled frame.
1532
Sanjoy Das2d161452015-11-18 06:23:38 +00001533The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1534operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1535involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1536through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1537appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1538inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1539continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1540E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1541
1542.. code-block:: llvm
1543
1544 define void @f() {
1545 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1546 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1547 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1548 ret void
1549 }
1550
1551 define void @g() {
1552 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1553 ret void
1554 }
1555
1556will result in
1557
1558.. code-block:: llvm
1559
1560 define void @g() {
1561 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1562 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1563 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1564 ret void
1565 }
1566
1567It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1568deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1569caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1570semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1571continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1572
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001573.. _moduleasm:
1574
1575Module-Level Inline Assembly
1576----------------------------
1577
1578Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1579to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1580concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1581in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1582
1583.. code-block:: llvm
1584
1585 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1586 module asm "more can go here"
1587
1588The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1589characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1590two digit hex code for the number.
1591
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00001592Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1593(unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001594
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +00001595.. _langref_datalayout:
1596
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001597Data Layout
1598-----------
1599
1600A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1601how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1602simply:
1603
1604.. code-block:: llvm
1605
1606 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1607
1608The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1609separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1610with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1611define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1612as follows:
1613
1614``E``
1615 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1616 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1617 location.
1618``e``
1619 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1620 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1621 location.
1622``S<size>``
1623 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1624 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1625 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1626 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1627 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1628 alignment promotions.
1629``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1630 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
1631 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. All sizes are in
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001632 bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001633 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001634 in the range [1,2^23).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001635``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1636 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1637 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1638``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1639 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1640 ``<size>``.
1641``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1642 This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
1643 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
1644 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
1645 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
1646 targets.
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001647``a:<abi>:<pref>``
1648 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
Rafael Espindola58873562014-01-03 19:21:54 +00001649``m:<mangling>``
Hans Wennborgd4245ac2014-01-15 02:49:17 +00001650 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The
1651 options are
1652
1653 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
1654 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
1655 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
1656 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
1657 * ``w``: Windows COFF prefix: Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall
1658 functions also get a suffix based on the frame size.
Saleem Abdulrasool70d2d642015-10-25 20:39:35 +00001659 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF prefix: Similar to Windows COFF, but use a ``_``
1660 prefix for ``__cdecl`` functions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001661``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
1662 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
1663 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
1664 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
1665 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
1666 efficiently.
1667
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001668On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
1669``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
1670should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
1671
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001672When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
1673default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
1674the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
1675specifications are given in this list:
1676
1677- ``E`` - big endian
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00001678- ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
1679- ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
1680 same as the default address space.
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001681- ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001682- ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1683- ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1684- ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
1685- ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
1686- ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
1687 alignment of 64-bits
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001688- ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001689- ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
1690- ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001691- ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001692- ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
1693- ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
Rafael Espindolae8f4d582013-12-12 17:21:51 +00001694- ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001695
1696When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
1697following rules:
1698
1699#. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
1700 that specification is used.
1701#. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
1702 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
1703 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
1704 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
1705 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
1706 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
1707 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
1708#. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
1709 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
1710 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
1711 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
1712
1713The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
1714Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
1715the code generator should use.
1716
1717Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
1718the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
1719mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001720what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
1721that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
1722don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
1723generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
1724accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
1725these default specifications.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001726
Bill Wendling5cc90842013-10-18 23:41:25 +00001727.. _langref_triple:
1728
1729Target Triple
1730-------------
1731
1732A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
1733host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
1734
1735.. code-block:: llvm
1736
1737 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
1738
1739The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
1740by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
1741
1742::
1743
1744 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
1745 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
1746
1747This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
1748code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
1749command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
1750
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001751.. _pointeraliasing:
1752
1753Pointer Aliasing Rules
1754----------------------
1755
1756Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
1757an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
1758undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
1759to the following rules:
1760
1761- A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
1762 value it is *based* on.
1763- An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
1764 of the variable's storage.
1765- The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
1766 address range of the allocated storage.
1767- A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
1768 address.
1769- An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
1770 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
1771 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
1772 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
1773 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
1774
1775A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
1776following rules:
1777
1778- A pointer value formed from a ``getelementptr`` operation is *based*
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001779 on the first value operand of the ``getelementptr``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001780- The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
1781 ``bitcast``.
1782- A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
1783 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
1784 the pointer's value.
1785- The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
1786
1787Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
1788definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
1789
1790LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
1791``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
1792which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
1793operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
1794alignment of the store.
1795
1796Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
1797``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
1798:ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
1799which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
1800alias analysis.
1801
1802.. _volatile:
1803
1804Volatile Memory Accesses
1805------------------------
1806
1807Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
1808:ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
1809marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
1810volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
1811volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
1812operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
1813"volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
1814
Andrew Trick89fc5a62013-01-30 21:19:35 +00001815IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
1816llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
1817flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
1818target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
1819
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00001820.. admonition:: Rationale
1821
1822 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
1823 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
1824 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
1825 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
1826 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001827 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00001828 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
1829
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001830.. _memmodel:
1831
1832Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
1833--------------------------------------
1834
1835The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
1836execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
1837platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
1838in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
1839
1840For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
1841
1842We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
1843that
1844
1845- Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
1846- When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
1847 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
1848 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
1849 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
1850 Constraints <ordering>`).
1851
1852Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
1853between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
1854
1855Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
1856loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
1857(defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
1858stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
1859section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
1860initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
1861of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
1862may see any write to the same byte, except:
1863
1864- If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
1865 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
1866 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
1867- If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
1868 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
1869
1870Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
1871
1872- If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
1873 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001874 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001875 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
1876 synchronization.)
1877- Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
1878 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
1879- Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
1880 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
1881- Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
1882 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
1883 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
1884 constraints on how the choice is made.
1885- Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
1886
1887R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
1888implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
1889the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
1890semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
1891than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
1892
1893Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
1894model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
1895is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
1896which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
1897(Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
1898from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
1899exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
1900
1901.. _ordering:
1902
1903Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
1904----------------------------------
1905
1906Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
1907:ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
1908:ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00001909ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001910the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
1911from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
1912descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
1913references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
1914:ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
1915differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
1916documentation for details.
1917
1918For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
1919:doc:`Atomics`.
1920
1921``unordered``
1922 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
1923 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
1924 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
1925 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
1926 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
1927 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
1928``monotonic``
1929 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
1930 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
1931 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
1932 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
1933 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
1934 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
1935 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
1936 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
1937 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
1938 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
1939 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
1940 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
1941 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
1942 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
1943 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
1944 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1945 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
1946``acquire``
1947 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
1948 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
1949 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
1950``release``
1951 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
1952 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
1953 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
1954 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
1955 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1956 ``memory_order_release``.
1957``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
1958 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
1959 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
1960``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
1961 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001962 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001963 writes), there is a global total order on all
1964 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
1965 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
1966 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
1967 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
1968 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1969 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
1970
1971.. _singlethread:
1972
1973If an atomic operation is marked ``singlethread``, it only *synchronizes
1974with* or participates in modification and seq\_cst total orderings with
1975other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal
1976handlers).
1977
1978.. _fastmath:
1979
1980Fast-Math Flags
1981---------------
1982
1983LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
1984:ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00001985:ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) have the following flags that can
1986be set to enable otherwise unsafe floating point operations
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001987
1988``nnan``
1989 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
1990 NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
1991 NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
1992
1993``ninf``
1994 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
1995 +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
1996 +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
1997
1998``nsz``
1999 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2000 argument or result as insignificant.
2001
2002``arcp``
2003 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2004 argument rather than perform division.
2005
2006``fast``
2007 Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may
2008 dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This
2009 flag implies all the others.
2010
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002011.. _uselistorder:
2012
2013Use-list Order Directives
2014-------------------------
2015
2016Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002017order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2018indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002019value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2020
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002021Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2022instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002023function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2024
2025If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2026``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2027function's scope.
2028
2029:Syntax:
2030
2031::
2032
2033 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2034 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2035
2036:Examples:
2037
2038::
2039
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith23046652014-08-19 21:48:04 +00002040 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2041 entry:
2042 ; ... instructions ...
2043 bb:
2044 ; ... instructions ...
2045
2046 ; At function scope.
2047 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2048 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2049 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002050
2051 ; At global scope.
2052 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2053 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2054 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2055 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2056
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002057.. _typesystem:
2058
2059Type System
2060===========
2061
2062The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2063intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2064optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2065directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2066transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2067generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2068not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2069
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002070.. _t_void:
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002071
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002072Void Type
2073---------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002074
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002075:Overview:
2076
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002077
2078The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2079
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002080:Syntax:
2081
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002082
2083::
2084
2085 void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002086
2087
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002088.. _t_function:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002089
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002090Function Type
2091-------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002092
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002093:Overview:
2094
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002095
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002096The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2097return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2098type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2099and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002100
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002101:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002102
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002103::
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002104
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002105 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002106
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002107...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2108specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002109indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002110argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002111handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002112except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002113
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002114:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002115
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002116+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2117| ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2118+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2119| ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2120+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2121| ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2122+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2123| ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2124+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2125
2126.. _t_firstclass:
2127
2128First Class Types
2129-----------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002130
2131The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2132Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2133instructions.
2134
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002135.. _t_single_value:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002136
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002137Single Value Types
2138^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002139
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002140These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002141
2142.. _t_integer:
2143
2144Integer Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002145""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002146
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002147:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002148
2149The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2150arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2151bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2152
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002153:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002154
2155::
2156
2157 iN
2158
2159The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2160value.
2161
2162Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002163*********
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002164
2165+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2166| ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2167+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2168| ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2169+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2170| ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2171+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2172
2173.. _t_floating:
2174
2175Floating Point Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002176""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002177
2178.. list-table::
2179 :header-rows: 1
2180
2181 * - Type
2182 - Description
2183
2184 * - ``half``
2185 - 16-bit floating point value
2186
2187 * - ``float``
2188 - 32-bit floating point value
2189
2190 * - ``double``
2191 - 64-bit floating point value
2192
2193 * - ``fp128``
2194 - 128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa)
2195
2196 * - ``x86_fp80``
2197 - 80-bit floating point value (X87)
2198
2199 * - ``ppc_fp128``
2200 - 128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits)
2201
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002202X86_mmx Type
2203""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002204
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002205:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002206
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002207The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002208machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2209return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2210instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2211and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2212of this type.
2213
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002214:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002215
2216::
2217
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002218 x86_mmx
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002219
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002220
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002221.. _t_pointer:
2222
2223Pointer Type
2224""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002225
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002226:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002227
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002228The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2229commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2230
2231Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2232numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2233address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2234are target-specific.
2235
2236Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2237permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002238
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002239:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002240
2241::
2242
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002243 <type> *
2244
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002245:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002246
2247+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2248| ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2249+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2250| ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2251+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2252| ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2253+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2254
2255.. _t_vector:
2256
2257Vector Type
2258"""""""""""
2259
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002260:Overview:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002261
2262A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2263elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2264operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2265requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2266type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2267
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002268:Syntax:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002269
2270::
2271
2272 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2273
2274The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
Manuel Jacob961f7872014-07-30 12:30:06 +00002275elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors
2276of size zero are not allowed.
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002277
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002278:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002279
2280+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2281| ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2282+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2283| ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2284+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2285| ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2286+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2287| ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2288+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002289
2290.. _t_label:
2291
2292Label Type
2293^^^^^^^^^^
2294
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002295:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002296
2297The label type represents code labels.
2298
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002299:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002300
2301::
2302
2303 label
2304
David Majnemerb611e3f2015-08-14 05:09:07 +00002305.. _t_token:
2306
2307Token Type
2308^^^^^^^^^^
2309
2310:Overview:
2311
2312The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2313but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2314As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2315:ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2316
2317:Syntax:
2318
2319::
2320
2321 token
2322
2323
2324
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002325.. _t_metadata:
2326
2327Metadata Type
2328^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2329
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002330:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002331
2332The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2333created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2334
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002335:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002336
2337::
2338
2339 metadata
2340
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002341.. _t_aggregate:
2342
2343Aggregate Types
2344^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2345
2346Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2347member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2348aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2349aggregate types.
2350
2351.. _t_array:
2352
2353Array Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002354""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002355
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002356:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002357
2358The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2359sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2360elements) and an underlying data type.
2361
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002362:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002363
2364::
2365
2366 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2367
2368The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2369be any type with a size.
2370
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002371:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002372
2373+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2374| ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2375+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2376| ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2377+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2378| ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2379+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2380
2381Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2382
2383+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2384| ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2385+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2386| ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating point values. |
2387+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2388| ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2389+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2390
2391There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2392by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2393bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2394single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2395LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2396arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2397example.
2398
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002399.. _t_struct:
2400
2401Structure Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002402""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002403
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002404:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002405
2406The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2407together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2408a size.
2409
2410Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2411getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2412Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2413'``insertvalue``' instructions.
2414
2415Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2416the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2417between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2418is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2419required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2420
2421Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2422is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2423identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2424Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2425or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2426recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2427
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002428:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002429
2430::
2431
2432 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2433 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2434
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002435:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002436
2437+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2438| ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2439+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00002440| ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002441+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2442| ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2443+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2444
2445.. _t_opaque:
2446
2447Opaque Structure Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002448""""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002449
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002450:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002451
2452Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2453do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2454notion of a forward declared structure.
2455
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002456:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002457
2458::
2459
2460 %X = type opaque
2461 %52 = type opaque
2462
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002463:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002464
2465+--------------+-------------------+
2466| ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2467+--------------+-------------------+
2468
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00002469.. _constants:
2470
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002471Constants
2472=========
2473
2474LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2475describes them all and their syntax.
2476
2477Simple Constants
2478----------------
2479
2480**Boolean constants**
2481 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2482 of the ``i1`` type.
2483**Integer constants**
2484 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2485 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2486 integer types.
2487**Floating point constants**
2488 Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2489 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2490 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2491 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2492 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2493 decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a :ref:`floating
2494 point <t_floating>` type.
2495**Null pointer constants**
2496 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2497 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
David Majnemerf0f224d2015-11-11 21:57:16 +00002498**Token constants**
2499 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2500 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002501
2502The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2503floating point constants. For example, the form
2504'``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2505than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating point
2506constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2507disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it
2508cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable
2509number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2510values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2511and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2512
2513When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2514double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2515matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
Dmitri Gribenko4dc2ba12013-01-16 23:40:37 +00002516must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002517precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2518double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2519by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2520128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2521``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
Richard Sandifordae426b42013-05-03 14:32:27 +00002522represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2523will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2524The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2525followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2526(sign bit at the left).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002527
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002528There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002529
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002530.. _complexconstants:
2531
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002532Complex Constants
2533-----------------
2534
2535Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2536constants and smaller complex constants.
2537
2538**Structure constants**
2539 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2540 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2541 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2542 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2543 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2544 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2545 must match those specified by the type.
2546**Array constants**
2547 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2548 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2549 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
2550 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
2551 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
Daniel Sandersf6051842014-09-11 12:02:59 +00002552 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
2553 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
2554 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002555**Vector constants**
2556 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
2557 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2558 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
2559 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
2560 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
2561 elements must match those specified by the type.
2562**Zero initialization**
2563 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
2564 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
2565 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
2566 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
2567 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
2568**Metadata node**
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002569 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
2570 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00002571 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
2572 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
2573 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002574 information such as debug info.
2575
2576Global Variable and Function Addresses
2577--------------------------------------
2578
2579The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
2580:ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
2581(link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
2582the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
2583:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
2584file:
2585
2586.. code-block:: llvm
2587
2588 @X = global i32 17
2589 @Y = global i32 42
2590 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
2591
2592.. _undefvalues:
2593
2594Undefined Values
2595----------------
2596
2597The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
2598indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
2599bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
2600or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
2601
2602Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
2603the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
2604compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
2605(potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
2606
2607.. code-block:: llvm
2608
2609 %A = add %X, undef
2610 %B = sub %X, undef
2611 %C = xor %X, undef
2612 Safe:
2613 %A = undef
2614 %B = undef
2615 %C = undef
2616
2617This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
2618bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
2619
2620.. code-block:: llvm
2621
2622 %A = or %X, undef
2623 %B = and %X, undef
2624 Safe:
2625 %A = -1
2626 %B = 0
2627 Unsafe:
2628 %A = undef
2629 %B = undef
2630
2631These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
2632input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
2633'``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
2634the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
2635optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
2636However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
26370, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
2638all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
2639allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
2640
2641.. code-block:: llvm
2642
2643 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
2644 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
2645 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
2646 Safe:
2647 %A = %X (or %Y)
2648 %B = 42 (or %Y)
2649 %C = %Y
2650 Unsafe:
2651 %A = undef
2652 %B = undef
2653 %C = undef
2654
2655This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
2656branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
2657of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
2658both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
2659cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
2660allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
2661``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
2662
2663.. code-block:: llvm
2664
2665 %A = xor undef, undef
2666
2667 %B = undef
2668 %C = xor %B, %B
2669
2670 %D = undef
Jonathan Roelofsec81c0b2014-10-16 19:28:10 +00002671 %E = icmp slt %D, 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002672 %F = icmp gte %D, 4
2673
2674 Safe:
2675 %A = undef
2676 %B = undef
2677 %C = undef
2678 %D = undef
2679 %E = undef
2680 %F = undef
2681
2682This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
2683necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
2684C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
2685``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
2686short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
2687its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
2688doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
2689read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
2690the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
2691``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
2692uses with" concept would not hold.
2693
2694.. code-block:: llvm
2695
2696 %A = fdiv undef, %X
2697 %B = fdiv %X, undef
2698 Safe:
2699 %A = undef
2700 b: unreachable
2701
2702These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
2703and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
2704allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
2705operation can be constant folded to '``undef``', because the '``undef``'
2706could be an SNaN, and ``fdiv`` is not (currently) defined on SNaN's.
2707However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
2708assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
2709we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
2710has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
2711does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
2712code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
2713optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
2714
2715.. code-block:: llvm
2716
2717 a: store undef -> %X
2718 b: store %X -> undef
2719 Safe:
2720 a: <deleted>
2721 b: unreachable
2722
2723These examples reiterate the ``fdiv`` example: a store *of* an undefined
2724value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the
2725value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already
2726there. However, a store *to* an undefined location could clobber
2727arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior.
2728
2729.. _poisonvalues:
2730
2731Poison Values
2732-------------
2733
2734Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
2735they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002736that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
2737that results in undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002738
2739There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
2740only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
2741the ``nsw`` flag.
2742
2743Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
2744
2745- Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
2746- :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
2747 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
2748- Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
2749 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
2750- :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
2751 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2752- :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
2753 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
2754 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2755- Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
2756 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
2757 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
2758 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
2759- An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
2760 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
2761 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
2762 operations <volatile>`.)
2763- An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
2764 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
2765 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
2766 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
2767 when control is transferred to another.
2768- Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
2769 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
2770 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
2771 successor.
2772- Dependence is transitive.
2773
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002774Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
2775with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002776on a poison value has undefined behavior.
2777
2778Here are some examples:
2779
2780.. code-block:: llvm
2781
2782 entry:
2783 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
2784 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00002785 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002786 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
2787
2788 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002789 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002790
2791 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
2792
2793 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
2794 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002795 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
2796 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002797
2798 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
2799 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
2800
2801 true:
2802 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
2803 ; it has undefined behavior.
2804 br label %end
2805
2806 end:
2807 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
2808 ; Both edges into this PHI are
2809 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
2810 ; always results in a poison value.
2811
2812 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
2813 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
2814 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
2815
2816 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
2817 ; The same branch again, but this time the
2818 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
2819
2820 second_true:
2821 ; No side effects!
2822 ret void
2823
2824 second_end:
2825 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
2826 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
2827 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
2828 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
2829 ; behavior in this example).
2830
2831.. _blockaddress:
2832
2833Addresses of Basic Blocks
2834-------------------------
2835
2836``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
2837
2838The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
2839basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
2840Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
2841
2842This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
2843':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
2844against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00002845undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002846no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
2847opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
2848allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
2849long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
2850instruction.
2851
2852Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
2853as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
2854
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002855.. _constantexprs:
2856
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002857Constant Expressions
2858--------------------
2859
2860Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
2861constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
2862:ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
2863that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
2864The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
2865
2866``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
2867 Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2868 larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2869``zext (CST to TYPE)``
2870 Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2871 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2872``sext (CST to TYPE)``
2873 Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2874 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2875``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
2876 Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type.
2877 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
2878 must be floating point.
2879``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
2880 Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
2881 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
2882 floating point.
2883``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
2884 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned
2885 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
2886 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
2887 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
2888 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
2889``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
2890 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed
2891 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
2892 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
2893 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
2894 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
2895``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
2896 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating
2897 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
2898 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
2899 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
2900 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
2901``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
2902 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating
2903 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
2904 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
2905 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
2906 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
2907``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
2908 Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer
Eli Bendersky9c0d4932013-03-11 16:51:15 +00002909 constant. ``TYPE`` must be an integer type. ``CST`` must be of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002910 pointer type. The ``CST`` value is zero extended, truncated, or
2911 unchanged to make it fit in ``TYPE``.
2912``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
2913 Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a
2914 pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero
2915 extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size.
2916 This one is *really* dangerous!
2917``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
2918 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the
2919 operands are the same as those for the :ref:`bitcast
2920 instruction <i_bitcast>`.
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00002921``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
2922 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
2923 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
2924 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00002925``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002926 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
2927 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
2928 instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00002929 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002930``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
2931 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
2932``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
2933 Performs the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
2934``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
2935 Performs the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
2936``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
2937 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
2938 constants.
2939``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
2940 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
2941 constants.
2942``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
2943 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
2944 constants.
2945``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
2946 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
2947 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
2948 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
2949 least one index value must be specified.
2950``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
2951 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
2952 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
2953 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
2954 value must be specified.
2955``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
2956 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
2957 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
2958 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
2959 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
2960 operations on floating point values are allowed).
2961
2962Other Values
2963============
2964
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002965.. _inlineasmexprs:
2966
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002967Inline Assembler Expressions
2968----------------------------
2969
2970LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00002971Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
2972represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
2973instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
2974flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
2975and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
2976stack conservatively.
2977
2978The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
2979followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
2980location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
2981be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
2982operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
2983
2984A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
2985other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
2986used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
2987resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
2988disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
2989syntax known to LLVM.
2990
2991LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
2992GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
2993modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
2994support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
2995described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
2996while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
2997translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
2998assembly.
2999
3000An example inline assembler expression is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003001
3002.. code-block:: llvm
3003
3004 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3005
3006Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3007of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3008Thus, typically we have:
3009
3010.. code-block:: llvm
3011
3012 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3013
3014Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3015marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3016'``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3017
3018.. code-block:: llvm
3019
3020 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3021
3022In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3023the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3024x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3025The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3026might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3027prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3028
3029.. code-block:: llvm
3030
3031 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3032
3033Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3034assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3035the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3036the only supported dialects. An example is:
3037
3038.. code-block:: llvm
3039
3040 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3041
3042If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3043first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3044keyword last.
3045
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003046Inline Asm Constraint String
3047^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3048
3049The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3050more constraint codes.
3051
3052For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3053operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3054string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3055second, etc.
3056
3057There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3058prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3059constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3060clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3061
3062There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3063
3064- Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3065 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3066 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3067- Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3068 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3069 modes used by the target.
3070- Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3071 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3072 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3073 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3074
3075Output constraints
3076""""""""""""""""""
3077
3078Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3079indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3080then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3081constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3082below about indirect outputs).
3083
3084Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3085expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3086the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3087assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3088the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3089modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
3090"early-clobber" output. Marking an ouput as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
3091will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3092output).
3093
3094Input constraints
3095"""""""""""""""""
3096
3097Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3098constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3099permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3100that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3101assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3102contain the same value.
3103
3104Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3105themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3106string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3107take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3108be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3109to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3110output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3111constraint).
3112
3113It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3114*other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3115(even when the other input has the same value).
3116
3117You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3118memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3119
3120There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3121register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3122type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3123registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3124
3125However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3126
3127Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3128architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3129instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3130SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3131hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3132feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3133
3134A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3135to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3136``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3137register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3138probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3139clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3140despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3141use)
3142
3143Indirect inputs and outputs
3144"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3145
3146Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3147(which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3148will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3149argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3150an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3151rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3152"output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3153memory location, instead of just read from it).
3154
3155This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3156address of a variable as a value.
3157
3158It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3159(e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3160value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3161input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3162functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3163statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3164optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3165
3166
3167Clobber constraints
3168"""""""""""""""""""
3169
3170A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3171consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3172general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3173constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3174"``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3175memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3176output.
3177
3178
3179Constraint Codes
3180""""""""""""""""
3181After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3182
3183A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3184followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3185(e.g. "``{eax}``").
3186
3187The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3188GCC's constraint codes.
3189
3190A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3191it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3192compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3193
3194There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3195inline asm constraint list:
3196
31971) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3198 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3199 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3200 constraint list.
3201
32022) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3203 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3204 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3205 constraint list will be chosen together.
3206
3207Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3208``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3209operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3210may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3211
3212However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3213LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3214point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3215in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3216compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3217always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3218or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3219doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3220unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3221``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3222intended.)
3223
3224Supported Constraint Code List
3225""""""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3226
3227The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3228GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3229inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3230and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3231
3232Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3233
3234- ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3235- ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3236 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3237 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3238- ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3239 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3240- ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3241- ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3242- ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3243 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3244
3245 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3246 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3247
3248- ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3249
3250Other constraints are target-specific:
3251
3252AArch64:
3253
3254- ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3255- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3256 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3257- ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3258 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3259- ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3260 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3261- ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3262 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3263- ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3264 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3265 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3266 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3267- ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3268 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3269- ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3270 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3271 well.)
3272- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3273- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3274- ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3275
3276AMDGPU:
3277
3278- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3279- ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3280- ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3281
3282
3283All ARM modes:
3284
3285- ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3286 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3287
3288ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3289
3290- ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3291- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3292- ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3293- ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3294 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3295 print the inverted value).
3296- ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3297 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3298 value).
3299- ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3300- ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3301- ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3302- ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3303- ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3304 as ``r``.
3305- ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3306 invalid.
3307- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3308 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3309- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3310 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3311- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3312 ``s0-s31``.
3313
3314ARM's Thumb1 mode:
3315
3316- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3317- ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3318- ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3319 some amount.
3320- ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3321- ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3322- ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3323- ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3324- ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3325- ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3326- ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3327- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3328 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3329- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3330 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3331- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3332 ``s0-s31``.
3333
3334
3335Hexagon:
3336
3337- ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3338 at the moment.
3339- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3340
3341MSP430:
3342
3343- ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3344
3345MIPS:
3346
3347- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3348- ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3349- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3350- ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3351- ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3352- ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3353- ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3354- ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3355 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3356- ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3357 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3358 ``m``.
3359- ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3360 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3361- ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3362- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003363 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3364 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003365- ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3366 ``25``).
3367- ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3368- ``x``: Invalid.
3369
3370NVPTX:
3371
3372- ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3373- ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3374- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3375- ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3376- ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3377- ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3378
3379
3380PowerPC:
3381
3382- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3383- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3384- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3385- ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3386- ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3387- ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3388- ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3389- ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3390 constant.
3391- ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3392 treated the same as ``m``.
3393- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3394- ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3395 ``R1-R31``).
3396- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3397 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3398- ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3399 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3400 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3401
3402 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3403 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3404
3405- ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3406- ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3407- ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3408 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3409- ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register
3410 set.
3411
3412Sparc:
3413
3414- ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3415- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3416
3417SystemZ:
3418
3419- ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3420- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3421- ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3422- ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3423- ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3424- ``Q``, ``R``, ``S``, ``T``: A memory address operand, treated the same as
3425 ``m``, at the moment.
3426- ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3427- ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3428 address context evaluates as zero).
3429- ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3430 (LLVM-specific)
3431- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register.
3432
3433X86:
3434
3435- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3436- ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3437- ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3438- ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3439 0xffffffff.
3440- ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3441- ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3442- ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3443- ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3444- ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3445- ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3446- ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3447 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3448 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3449- ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3450 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3451- ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3452- ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3453 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3454- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3455- ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3456- ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3457 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3458 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3459 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3460- ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3461- ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3462 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3463 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3464 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3465 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3466 statement.
3467
3468XCore:
3469
3470- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3471
3472
3473.. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3474
3475Asm template argument modifiers
3476^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3477
3478In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3479"``${0:n}``".
3480
3481The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3482GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3483inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3484and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3485
3486Target-independent:
3487
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003488- ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003489 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3490- ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3491 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3492- ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3493 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3494
3495AArch64:
3496
3497- ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3498 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3499- ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3500- ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3501 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3502 ``v*``.
3503
3504AMDGPU:
3505
3506- ``r``: No effect.
3507
3508ARM:
3509
3510- ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3511 register).
3512- ``P``: No effect.
3513- ``q``: No effect.
3514- ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3515 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3516- ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3517 prefix.
3518- ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3519- ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3520 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3521- ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3522 register of a two-register operand.
3523- ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3524 register of a two-register operand.
3525- ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3526 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
3527 to ``R``.)
3528
3529 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
3530 of a two-register operand.
3531
3532- ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3533- ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3534- ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
3535 adornment.
3536
3537Hexagon:
3538
3539- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3540 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3541
3542 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3543 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3544
3545- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3546 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3547
3548MSP430:
3549
3550No additional modifiers.
3551
3552MIPS:
3553
3554- ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
3555- ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
3556- ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
3557- ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
3558- ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
3559- ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3560 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3561
3562 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
3563
3564- ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3565 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3566
3567 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
3568
3569- ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3570 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
3571 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
3572 ``M``.)
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003573- ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
3574 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
3575 constraint.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003576
3577NVPTX:
3578
3579- ``r``: No effect.
3580
3581PowerPC:
3582
3583- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3584 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3585
3586 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3587 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3588
3589- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3590 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3591- ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
3592 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
3593- ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
3594 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
3595 always print nothing)
3596- ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
3597 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
3598
3599Sparc:
3600
3601- ``r``: No effect.
3602
3603SystemZ:
3604
3605SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
3606target-independent modifiers.
3607
3608X86:
3609
3610- ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
3611 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
3612- ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
3613- ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
3614 operand.
3615- ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
3616 memory operand.
3617- ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
3618 operand.
3619- ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
3620 operand.
3621- ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
3622 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
3623- ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
3624 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
3625 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
3626 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
3627- ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
3628- ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
3629 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
3630
3631XCore:
3632
3633No additional modifiers.
3634
3635
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003636Inline Asm Metadata
3637^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3638
3639The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
3640"``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
3641integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
3642location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
3643error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
3644errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
3645it. For example:
3646
3647.. code-block:: llvm
3648
3649 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
3650 ...
3651 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
3652
3653It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
3654in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
3655will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
3656occurs on.
3657
3658.. _metadata:
3659
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003660Metadata
3661========
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003662
3663LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
3664that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
3665code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
3666debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003667
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003668Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003669``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
3670
3671All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
3672
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003673.. _metadata-string:
3674
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003675Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
3676-----------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003677
3678A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
3679contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
3680"``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
3681"``!"test\00"``".
3682
3683Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
3684constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
3685preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
3686their operand. For example:
3687
3688.. code-block:: llvm
3689
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003690 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003691
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00003692Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
3693
3694.. code-block:: llvm
3695
3696 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
3697
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00003698``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003699content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00003700when metadata operands change.
3701
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003702A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
3703metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
3704example:
3705
3706.. code-block:: llvm
3707
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003708 !foo = !{!4, !3}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003709
3710Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here ``llvm.dbg.value``
3711function is using two metadata arguments:
3712
3713.. code-block:: llvm
3714
3715 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25)
3716
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00003717Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
3718to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003719
3720.. code-block:: llvm
3721
3722 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
3723
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00003724Metadata can also be attached to a function definition. Here metadata ``!22``
3725is attached to the ``foo`` function using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
3726
3727.. code-block:: llvm
3728
3729 define void @foo() !dbg !22 {
3730 ret void
3731 }
3732
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003733More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
3734optimizers and code generator is found below.
3735
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003736.. _specialized-metadata:
3737
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003738Specialized Metadata Nodes
3739^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3740
3741Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003742to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003743order.
3744
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003745These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
3746metadata nodes are related to debug info.
3747
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003748.. _DICompileUnit:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003749
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003750DICompileUnit
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003751"""""""""""""
3752
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003753``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00003754``retainedTypes:``, ``subprograms:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:``
3755fields are tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile
3756unit, regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003757references to them from instructions).
3758
3759.. code-block:: llvm
3760
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003761 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003762 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
3763 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: 1,
3764 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4,
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00003765 globals: !5, imports: !6, macros: !7, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003766
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003767Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003768specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope.
3769These descriptors are collected by a named metadata ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003770keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported
3771entities (declarations and namespaces).
3772
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003773.. _DIFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003774
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003775DIFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003776""""""
3777
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003778``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003779
3780.. code-block:: llvm
3781
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003782 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003783
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003784Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
3785for ``file:`` fields.
3786
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00003787.. _DIBasicType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003788
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003789DIBasicType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003790"""""""""""
3791
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003792``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003793``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003794
3795.. code-block:: llvm
3796
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003797 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003798 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003799 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003800
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003801The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003802following:
3803
3804.. code-block:: llvm
3805
3806 DW_ATE_address = 1
3807 DW_ATE_boolean = 2
3808 DW_ATE_float = 4
3809 DW_ATE_signed = 5
3810 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
3811 DW_ATE_unsigned = 7
3812 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
3813
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003814.. _DISubroutineType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003815
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003816DISubroutineType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003817""""""""""""""""
3818
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003819``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003820refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003821types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003822represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
3823
3824.. code-block:: llvm
3825
3826 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
3827 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003828 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003829
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003830.. _DIDerivedType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003831
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003832DIDerivedType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003833"""""""""""""
3834
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003835``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003836qualified types.
3837
3838.. code-block:: llvm
3839
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003840 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003841 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003842 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003843 align: 32)
3844
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003845The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
3846
3847.. code-block:: llvm
3848
3849 DW_TAG_formal_parameter = 5
3850 DW_TAG_member = 13
3851 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
3852 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
3853 DW_TAG_typedef = 22
3854 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
3855 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
3856 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
3857 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
3858
3859``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003860<DICompositeType>` or :ref:`subprogram <DISubprogram>`. The type of the member
3861is the ``baseType:``. The ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003862``DW_TAG_formal_parameter`` is used to define a member which is a formal
3863argument of a subprogram.
3864
3865``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
3866
3867``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
3868``DW_TAG_volatile_type`` and ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` are used to qualify the
3869``baseType:``.
3870
3871Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
3872
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003873.. _DICompositeType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003874
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003875DICompositeType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003876"""""""""""""""
3877
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003878``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003879structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003880
3881If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003882identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified, other types
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003883can refer to composite types indirectly via a :ref:`metadata string
3884<metadata-string>` that matches their identifier.
3885
3886.. code-block:: llvm
3887
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003888 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
3889 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
3890 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
3891 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003892 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
3893 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
3894
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003895The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
3896
3897.. code-block:: llvm
3898
3899 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
3900 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
3901 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
3902 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
3903 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
3904 DW_TAG_subroutine_type = 21
3905 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
3906
3907
3908For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003909descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003910level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003911array type is a native packed vector.
3912
3913For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003914descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003915value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003916``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003917
3918For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
3919``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003920<DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member`` or ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003921
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003922.. _DISubrange:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003923
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003924DISubrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003925""""""""""
3926
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003927``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003928:ref:`DICompositeType`. ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003929
3930.. code-block:: llvm
3931
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003932 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
3933 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
3934 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003935
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003936.. _DIEnumerator:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003937
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003938DIEnumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003939""""""""""""
3940
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003941``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
3942variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003943
3944.. code-block:: llvm
3945
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003946 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
3947 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
3948 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003949
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003950DITemplateTypeParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003951"""""""""""""""""""""""
3952
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003953``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003954language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003955:ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003956
3957.. code-block:: llvm
3958
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003959 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003960
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003961DITemplateValueParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003962""""""""""""""""""""""""
3963
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003964``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003965language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003966but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003967``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003968:ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003969
3970.. code-block:: llvm
3971
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003972 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003973
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003974DINamespace
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003975"""""""""""
3976
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003977``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003978
3979.. code-block:: llvm
3980
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003981 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003982
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003983DIGlobalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003984""""""""""""""""
3985
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003986``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003987
3988.. code-block:: llvm
3989
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003990 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003991 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
3992 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
3993 declaration: !4)
3994
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003995All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003996:ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003997
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003998.. _DISubprogram:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003999
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004000DISubprogram
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004001""""""""""""
4002
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004003``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4004``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4005metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4006that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4007the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004008
4009.. code-block:: llvm
4010
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004011 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4012 ...
4013 }
4014
4015 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4016 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4017 isDefinition: false, scopeLine: 8,
4018 containingType: !4,
4019 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4020 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4021 isOptimized: true, templateParams: !5,
4022 declaration: !6, variables: !7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004023
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004024.. _DILexicalBlock:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004025
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004026DILexicalBlock
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004027""""""""""""""
4028
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004029``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004030<DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004031two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004032fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004033
4034.. code-block:: llvm
4035
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004036 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004037
4038Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4039operands.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004040
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004041.. _DILexicalBlockFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004042
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004043DILexicalBlockFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004044""""""""""""""""""
4045
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004046``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004047:ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004048indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4049discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4050
4051.. code-block:: llvm
4052
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004053 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4054 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4055 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004056
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00004057.. _DILocation:
4058
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004059DILocation
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004060""""""""""
4061
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004062``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004063mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4064:ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004065
4066.. code-block:: llvm
4067
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004068 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004069
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004070.. _DILocalVariable:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004071
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004072DILocalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004073"""""""""""""""
4074
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004075``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004076the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4077parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4078:ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004079
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004080.. code-block:: llvm
4081
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004082 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4083 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4084 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4085 type: !3)
4086 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004087
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004088DIExpression
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004089""""""""""""
4090
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004091``DIExpression`` nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004092:ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>` (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare``) to
4093describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language
4094variable.
4095
4096The current supported vocabulary is limited:
4097
4098- ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the working expression.
4099- ``DW_OP_plus, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4100- ``DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4101 here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression.
4102
4103.. code-block:: llvm
4104
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004105 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4106 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3)
4107 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4108 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004109
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004110DIObjCProperty
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004111""""""""""""""
4112
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004113``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004114
4115.. code-block:: llvm
4116
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004117 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004118 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4119
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004120DIImportedEntity
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004121""""""""""""""""
4122
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004123``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004124compile unit.
4125
4126.. code-block:: llvm
4127
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004128 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004129 entity: !1, line: 7)
4130
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004131DIMacro
4132"""""""
4133
4134``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4135The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
4136definining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
4137used to expand the macro identifier.
4138
4139.. code-block:: llvm
4140
4141 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4142 value: "((x) + 1)")
4143 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4144
4145DIMacroFile
4146"""""""""""
4147
4148``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4149The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4150appear in the included source file.
4151
4152.. code-block:: llvm
4153
4154 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4155 nodes: !3)
4156
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004157'``tbaa``' Metadata
4158^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4159
4160In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4161suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to
4162describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to
4163implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement
4164custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4165
4166The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up
4167to three fields, e.g.:
4168
4169.. code-block:: llvm
4170
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004171 !0 = !{ !"an example type tree" }
4172 !1 = !{ !"int", !0 }
4173 !2 = !{ !"float", !0 }
4174 !3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004175
4176The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a
4177metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important
4178name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different
4179root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with
4180common names.
4181
4182The second field identifies the type's parent node in the tree, or is
4183null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of
4184its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is
4185considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced
4186from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively.
4187
4188If the third field is present, it's an integer which if equal to 1
4189indicates that the type is "constant" (meaning
4190``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
4191AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_).
4192
4193'``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4194^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4195
4196The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4197aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4198is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4199strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4200padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4201of the aggregate.
4202
4203``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4204memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4205
4206The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4207nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4208For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4209field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4210its tbaa tag. e.g.:
4211
4212.. code-block:: llvm
4213
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004214 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004215
4216This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4217with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4218and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4219
4220Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
42214 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4222does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4223
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004224'``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
Dan Liewbafdcba2014-07-28 13:33:51 +00004225^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004226
4227``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4228noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4229instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4230``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4231collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004232Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00004233a domain. When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004234of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
Arch D. Robison96cf7ab2015-02-24 20:11:49 +00004235subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004236instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4237alias.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004238
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004239The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4240entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004241string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004242self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4243descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4244
4245The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4246three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004247is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004248self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4249reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4250optionally be provided as a third list entry.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004251
4252For example,
4253
4254.. code-block:: llvm
4255
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004256 ; Two scope domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004257 !0 = !{!0}
4258 !1 = !{!1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004259
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004260 ; Some scopes in these domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004261 !2 = !{!2, !0}
4262 !3 = !{!3, !0}
4263 !4 = !{!4, !1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004264
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004265 ; Some scope lists:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004266 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4267 !6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
4268 !7 = !{!3}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004269
4270 ; These two instructions don't alias:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004271 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004272 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004273
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004274 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
4275 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004276 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004277 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004278
Adam Nemet0a8416f2015-05-11 08:30:28 +00004279 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004280 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
4281 ; !alias.scope list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004282 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004283 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004284
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004285'``fpmath``' Metadata
4286^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4287
4288``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point
4289type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
4290result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
4291compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
4292it. ULP is defined as follows:
4293
4294 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
4295 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
4296 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
4297 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
4298 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
4299
4300The metadata node shall consist of a single positive floating point
4301number representing the maximum relative error, for example:
4302
4303.. code-block:: llvm
4304
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004305 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004306
Philip Reamesf8bf9dd2015-02-27 23:14:50 +00004307.. _range-metadata:
4308
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004309'``range``' Metadata
4310^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4311
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004312``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
4313integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
4314returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
4315represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
4316returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
4317pair. Each pair has the following properties:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004318
4319- The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
4320- The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
4321- Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
4322- The range is allowed to wrap.
4323- The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
4324 ``a!=b``.
4325
4326In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
4327they must be non-contiguous.
4328
4329Examples:
4330
4331.. code-block:: llvm
4332
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004333 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
4334 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004335 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
4336 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
4337 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004338 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004339 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
4340 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
4341 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
4342 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004343
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00004344'``unpredictable``' Metadata
Sanjay Patel1f12b342015-09-02 19:35:31 +00004345^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00004346
4347``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
4348instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
4349flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
4350optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
4351is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
4352or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
4353
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004354'``llvm.loop``'
4355^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4356
4357It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
4358loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
4359in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00004360guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004361specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004362
4363The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +00004364itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
4365during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
4366to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
4367The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004368constructs:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004369
4370.. code-block:: llvm
Paul Redmondeaaed3b2013-02-21 17:20:45 +00004371
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004372 !0 = !{!0}
4373 !1 = !{!1}
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004374
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004375The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
4376per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
4377as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
4378suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004379
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004380.. code-block:: llvm
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004381
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004382 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
4383 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004384 !0 = !{!0, !1}
4385 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004386
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004387'``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
4388^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004389
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004390Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
4391used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004392vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
4393conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004394``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
4395optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004396it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004397which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
4398in determining the safety of these transformations.
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004399
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004400'``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004401^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4402
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004403This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
4404The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004405second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
4406example:
4407
4408.. code-block:: llvm
4409
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004410 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004411
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004412Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004413multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004414then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
4415
4416'``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
Dan Liew9a1829d2014-07-22 14:59:38 +00004417^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004418
4419This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
4420first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004421is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +000044220 disables vectorization:
4423
4424.. code-block:: llvm
4425
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004426 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
4427 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004428
4429'``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
4430^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4431
4432This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
4433operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
4434operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
4435
4436.. code-block:: llvm
4437
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004438 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004439
4440Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004441vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +000044420 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
4443determined automatically.
4444
4445'``llvm.loop.unroll``'
4446^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4447
4448Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
4449optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
4450metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
4451identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
4452optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
4453optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
4454
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004455'``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
4456^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4457
4458This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
4459first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
4460operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
4461example:
4462
4463.. code-block:: llvm
4464
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004465 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004466
4467If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
4468will be partially unrolled.
4469
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004470'``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
4471^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4472
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004473This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004474which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004475
4476.. code-block:: llvm
4477
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004478 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004479
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004480'``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
Dan Liew868b0742015-03-11 13:34:49 +00004481^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004482
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004483This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004484operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004485
4486.. code-block:: llvm
4487
4488 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
4489
Mark Heffernan89391542015-08-10 17:28:08 +00004490'``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
4491^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4492
4493This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
4494is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
4495at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
4496``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
4497
4498.. code-block:: llvm
4499
4500 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
4501
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004502'``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
4503^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4504
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004505This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
4506metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004507For example:
4508
4509.. code-block:: llvm
4510
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004511 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004512
4513'``llvm.mem``'
4514^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4515
4516Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
4517for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
4518
4519'``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
4520^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4521
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004522The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
4523or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
4524The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
4525no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004526with the same loop identifier.
4527
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004528Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
4529``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
4530set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
4531carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004532``L2``.
4533
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004534As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
4535``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
4536loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
4537loop.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004538
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004539Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
4540the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004541memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004542safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
4543sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004544insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004545
4546Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004547both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004548metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
4549
4550.. code-block:: llvm
4551
4552 for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004553 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004554 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004555 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004556 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004557 ...
4558 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004559
4560 for.end:
4561 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004562 !0 = !{!0}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004563
4564It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
4565memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
4566the loop identifier metadata node directly:
4567
4568.. code-block:: llvm
4569
4570 outer.for.body:
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004571 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004572 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004573 ...
4574 br label %inner.for.body
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004575
4576 inner.for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004577 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004578 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004579 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004580 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004581 ...
4582 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004583
4584 inner.for.end:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004585 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004586 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004587 ...
4588 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004589
4590 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
4591 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004592 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
4593 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
4594 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004595
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +00004596'``llvm.bitsets``'
4597^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4598
4599The ``llvm.bitsets`` global metadata is used to implement
4600:doc:`bitsets <BitSets>`.
4601
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00004602'``invariant.group``' Metadata
4603^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4604
4605The ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to ``load``/``store`` instructions.
4606The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
4607the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
4608within the same invariant group can be assumed to load or store the same
4609value (but see the ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` intrinsic which affects
4610when two pointers are considered the same).
4611
4612Examples:
4613
4614.. code-block:: llvm
4615
4616 @unknownPtr = external global i8
4617 ...
4618 %ptr = alloca i8
4619 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
4620 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4621
4622 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
4623 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4624 %b = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !1 ; Can't assume anything, because group changed
4625
4626 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
4627 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
4628
4629 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
4630 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
4631
4632 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4633 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* %ptr)
4634 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through invariant.group.barrier to get value of %ptr
4635
4636 ...
4637 declare void @foo(i8*)
4638 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
4639 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8*)
4640
4641 !0 = !{!"magic ptr"}
4642 !1 = !{!"other ptr"}
4643
4644
4645
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004646Module Flags Metadata
4647=====================
4648
4649Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
4650subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
4651The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004652this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
4653dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004654look it up.
4655
4656The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
4657Each triplet has the following form:
4658
4659- The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
4660 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
4661 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
4662 described below.
4663- The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004664 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
4665 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004666- The third element is the value of the flag.
4667
4668When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004669``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
4670each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
4671modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
4672be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
4673is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004674
4675The following behaviors are supported:
4676
4677.. list-table::
4678 :header-rows: 1
4679 :widths: 10 90
4680
4681 * - Value
4682 - Behavior
4683
4684 * - 1
4685 - **Error**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004686 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
4687 is that of the operands.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004688
4689 * - 2
4690 - **Warning**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004691 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
4692 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004693
4694 * - 3
4695 - **Require**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004696 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
4697 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
4698 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
4699 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
4700 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
4701 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
4702 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004703
4704 * - 4
4705 - **Override**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004706 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
4707 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
4708 differ, an error will be emitted.
4709
Daniel Dunbard77d9fb2013-01-16 21:38:56 +00004710 * - 5
4711 - **Append**
4712 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
4713
4714 * - 6
4715 - **AppendUnique**
4716 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
4717 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
4718 during the append operation.
4719
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004720It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
4721except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
4722value) or **Override**.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004723
4724An example of module flags:
4725
4726.. code-block:: llvm
4727
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004728 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
4729 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
4730 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
4731 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
4732 !{
4733 !"foo", i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004734 }
4735 }
4736 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
4737
4738- Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
4739 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
4740 values are not equal.
4741
4742- Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
4743 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004744 '37'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004745
4746- Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
4747 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
4748 warning if their values are not equal.
4749
4750- Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
4751
4752 ::
4753
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004754 !{ !"foo", i32 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004755
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004756 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
4757 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
4758 performed.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004759
4760Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
4761----------------------------------------------------
4762
4763On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
4764collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
4765consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
4766garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
4767modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
4768be merged rather than appended together.
4769
4770The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
4771following key-value pairs:
4772
4773.. list-table::
4774 :header-rows: 1
4775 :widths: 30 70
4776
4777 * - Key
4778 - Value
4779
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004780 * - ``Objective-C Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004781 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004782
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004783 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004784 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004785 always 0.
4786
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004787 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004788 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004789 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
4790 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
4791 Objective-C ABI version 2.
4792
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004793 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004794 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004795 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
4796 collection supported.
4797
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004798 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004799 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004800 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
4801 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
4802
4803Some important flag interactions:
4804
4805- If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
4806 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
4807 2, then the resulting module has the
4808 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
4809- A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
4810 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
4811
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004812Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata
4813--------------------------------------------
4814
4815Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
4816files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
4817allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
4818these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
4819
4820These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section,
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004821using the ``Linker Options`` key. The merge behavior for this flag is required
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004822to be ``AppendUnique``, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata
4823node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
4824list of metadata strings defining linker options.
4825
4826For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
4827linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
4828framework::
4829
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004830 !0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options",
4831 !{
4832 !{ !"-lz" },
4833 !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004834 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 }
4835
4836The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
4837list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
4838strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
4839preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
4840assembly writer or object file emitter.
4841
4842Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
4843linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
4844object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
4845
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00004846C type width Module Flags Metadata
4847----------------------------------
4848
4849The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
4850options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
4851linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
4852of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
4853width.
4854
4855To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
4856flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
4857
4858.. list-table::
4859 :header-rows: 1
4860 :widths: 30 70
4861
4862 * - Key
4863 - Value
4864
4865 * - short_wchar
4866 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
4867 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
4868
4869 * - short_enum
4870 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
4871 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
4872 represent all of its values.
4873
4874For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
4875compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
4876enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
4877
4878 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004879 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
4880 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00004881
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004882.. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
4883
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004884Intrinsic Global Variables
4885==========================
4886
4887LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
4888affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
4889All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
4890"``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
4891"``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
4892
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004893.. _gv_llvmused:
4894
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004895The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
4896-----------------------------------
4897
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00004898The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
Paul Redmond219ef812013-05-30 17:24:32 +00004899:ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00004900pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
4901have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004902use of it is:
4903
4904.. code-block:: llvm
4905
4906 @X = global i8 4
4907 @Y = global i32 123
4908
4909 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
4910 i8* @X,
4911 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
4912 ], section "llvm.metadata"
4913
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00004914If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
4915and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00004916symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
4917a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
4918``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
4919references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
4920corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004921
4922On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
4923assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
4924molesting the symbol.
4925
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004926.. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
4927
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004928The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
4929--------------------------------------------
4930
4931The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
4932directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
4933symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
4934optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
4935by ``@llvm.used``.
4936
4937This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
4938and should not be exposed to source languages.
4939
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004940.. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
4941
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004942The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
4943-------------------------------------------
4944
4945.. code-block:: llvm
4946
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004947 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
4948 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004949
4950The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004951functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
4952The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
4953of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
4954functions with the same priority is not defined.
4955
4956If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
4957or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
4958data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004959
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004960.. _llvmglobaldtors:
4961
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004962The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
4963-------------------------------------------
4964
4965.. code-block:: llvm
4966
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004967 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
4968 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004969
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004970The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
4971functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
4972The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
Reid Klecknerbffbcc52014-05-27 21:35:17 +00004973order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004974order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
4975
4976If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
4977or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
4978data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004979
4980Instruction Reference
4981=====================
4982
4983The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
4984of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
4985instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
4986instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
4987:ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
4988
4989.. _terminators:
4990
4991Terminator Instructions
4992-----------------------
4993
4994As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
4995program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
4996block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
4997terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
4998control flow, not values (the one exception being the
4999':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
5000
5001The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
5002':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
5003':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005004':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005005':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
5006':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005007and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005008
5009.. _i_ret:
5010
5011'``ret``' Instruction
5012^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5013
5014Syntax:
5015"""""""
5016
5017::
5018
5019 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
5020 ret void ; Return from void function
5021
5022Overview:
5023"""""""""
5024
5025The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
5026a value) from a function back to the caller.
5027
5028There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
5029value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
5030flow to occur.
5031
5032Arguments:
5033""""""""""
5034
5035The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
5036return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
5037class <t_firstclass>`' type.
5038
5039A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
5040return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
5041a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
5042void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
5043value.
5044
5045Semantics:
5046""""""""""
5047
5048When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
5049the calling function's context. If the caller is a
5050":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5051instruction after the call. If the caller was an
5052":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5053beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
5054a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
5055value.
5056
5057Example:
5058""""""""
5059
5060.. code-block:: llvm
5061
5062 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
5063 ret void ; Return from a void function
5064 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
5065
5066.. _i_br:
5067
5068'``br``' Instruction
5069^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5070
5071Syntax:
5072"""""""
5073
5074::
5075
5076 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
5077 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
5078
5079Overview:
5080"""""""""
5081
5082The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
5083different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
5084this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
5085unconditional branch.
5086
5087Arguments:
5088""""""""""
5089
5090The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
5091'``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
5092'``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
5093
5094Semantics:
5095""""""""""
5096
5097Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
5098argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
5099'``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
5100to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
5101
5102Example:
5103""""""""
5104
5105.. code-block:: llvm
5106
5107 Test:
5108 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
5109 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
5110 IfEqual:
5111 ret i32 1
5112 IfUnequal:
5113 ret i32 0
5114
5115.. _i_switch:
5116
5117'``switch``' Instruction
5118^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5119
5120Syntax:
5121"""""""
5122
5123::
5124
5125 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
5126
5127Overview:
5128"""""""""
5129
5130The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
5131several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
5132instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
5133destinations.
5134
5135Arguments:
5136""""""""""
5137
5138The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
5139comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
5140array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
5141is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
5142
5143Semantics:
5144""""""""""
5145
5146The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
5147When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
5148for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
5149to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
5150to the default destination.
5151
5152Implementation:
5153"""""""""""""""
5154
5155Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
5156``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
5157different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
5158chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
5159
5160Example:
5161""""""""
5162
5163.. code-block:: llvm
5164
5165 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
5166 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
5167 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
5168
5169 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
5170 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
5171
5172 ; Implement a jump table:
5173 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
5174 i32 1, label %onone
5175 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
5176
5177.. _i_indirectbr:
5178
5179'``indirectbr``' Instruction
5180^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5181
5182Syntax:
5183"""""""
5184
5185::
5186
5187 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
5188
5189Overview:
5190"""""""""
5191
5192The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
5193label within the current function, whose address is specified by
5194"``address``". Address must be derived from a
5195:ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
5196
5197Arguments:
5198""""""""""
5199
5200The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
5201rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
5202that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
5203times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
5204
5205This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
5206accurate understanding of the CFG.
5207
5208Semantics:
5209""""""""""
5210
5211Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
5212possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
5213this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
5214labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
5215
5216Implementation:
5217"""""""""""""""
5218
5219This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
5220
5221Example:
5222""""""""
5223
5224.. code-block:: llvm
5225
5226 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
5227
5228.. _i_invoke:
5229
5230'``invoke``' Instruction
5231^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5232
5233Syntax:
5234"""""""
5235
5236::
5237
5238 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ptr to function ty> <function ptr val>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00005239 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005240
5241Overview:
5242"""""""""
5243
5244The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
5245function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
5246'``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
5247returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
5248"normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
5249":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
5250mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
5251nearest "exception" label.
5252
5253The '``exception``' label is a `landing
5254pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
5255'``exception``' label is required to have the
5256":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
5257information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
5258as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
5259"``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
5260instruction, so that the important information contained within the
5261"``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
5262
5263Arguments:
5264""""""""""
5265
5266This instruction requires several arguments:
5267
5268#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
5269 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
5270 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
5271#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
5272 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
5273 are valid here.
5274#. '``ptr to function ty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to
5275 function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct
5276 function invocation, but indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible,
5277 branching off an arbitrary pointer to function value.
5278#. '``function ptr val``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a
5279 function to be invoked.
5280#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
5281 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
5282 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
5283 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
5284 extra arguments can be specified.
5285#. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
5286 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
5287#. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
5288 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
5289 mechanism.
5290#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
5291 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
5292 attributes are valid here.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00005293#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005294
5295Semantics:
5296""""""""""
5297
5298This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
5299instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
5300establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
5301library to unwind the stack.
5302
5303This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
5304proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
5305thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
5306'``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
5307
5308For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
5309by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
5310current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
5311return value is available.
5312
5313Example:
5314""""""""
5315
5316.. code-block:: llvm
5317
5318 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005319 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005320 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005321 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005322
5323.. _i_resume:
5324
5325'``resume``' Instruction
5326^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5327
5328Syntax:
5329"""""""
5330
5331::
5332
5333 resume <type> <value>
5334
5335Overview:
5336"""""""""
5337
5338The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
5339successors.
5340
5341Arguments:
5342""""""""""
5343
5344The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
5345same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
5346function.
5347
5348Semantics:
5349""""""""""
5350
5351The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
5352(in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
5353:ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
5354
5355Example:
5356""""""""
5357
5358.. code-block:: llvm
5359
5360 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
5361
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005362.. _i_catchswitch:
5363
5364'``catchswitch``' Instruction
Akira Hatanakacedf8e92015-12-14 05:15:40 +00005365^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005366
5367Syntax:
5368"""""""
5369
5370::
5371
5372 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
5373 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
5374
5375Overview:
5376"""""""""
5377
5378The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
5379<ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
5380that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
5381
5382Arguments:
5383""""""""""
5384
5385The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
5386``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
5387this operand may be the token ``none``.
5388
5389The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with a
David Majnemerbbfc7212015-12-14 18:34:23 +00005390"pad" instruction, one of ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch``.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005391
5392The ``handlers`` are a list of successor blocks that each begin with a
5393:ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
5394
5395Semantics:
5396""""""""""
5397
5398Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
5399``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
5400present.
5401
5402The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
5403it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
5404block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
5405
5406Example:
5407""""""""
5408
5409.. code-block:: llvm
5410
5411 dispatch1:
5412 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
5413 dispatch2:
5414 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
5415
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005416.. _i_catchpad:
5417
5418'``catchpad``' Instruction
Akira Hatanakacedf8e92015-12-14 05:15:40 +00005419^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005420
5421Syntax:
5422"""""""
5423
5424::
5425
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005426 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005427
5428Overview:
5429"""""""""
5430
5431The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
5432system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005433begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005434control to catch an exception.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005435
5436Arguments:
5437""""""""""
5438
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005439The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
5440:ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
5441ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
5442terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005443
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005444The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
5445requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
5446will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
5447the exception.
5448
5449The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
5450``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
5451pads.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005452
5453Semantics:
5454""""""""""
5455
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005456When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
5457exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
5458not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
5459entirely target and personality function-specific.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005460
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005461Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
5462instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005463
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005464The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
5465instructions is described in the
5466`Windows exception handling documentation <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`.
5467
5468Executing a ``catchpad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad.
5469The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways:
54701) explicitly via a ``catchret`` that consumes it. Executing such a ``catchret``
5471 is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet
5472 exited.
54732) implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller),
David Majnemerbbfc7212015-12-14 18:34:23 +00005474 or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +000054753) implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of
5476 the ``catchpad``. When the ``catchpad`` is exited in this manner, it is
5477 undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an
5478 ancestor of the ``catchpad`` being exited.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005479
5480Example:
5481""""""""
5482
5483.. code-block:: llvm
5484
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005485 dispatch:
5486 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005487 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005488 handler0:
5489 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005490
5491.. _i_catchret:
5492
5493'``catchret``' Instruction
5494^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5495
5496Syntax:
5497"""""""
5498
5499::
5500
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005501 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005502
5503Overview:
5504"""""""""
5505
5506The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
5507single successor.
5508
5509
5510Arguments:
5511""""""""""
5512
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00005513The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
5514exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
5515The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
5516transfer to next.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005517
5518Semantics:
5519""""""""""
5520
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005521The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
5522unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
5523:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
5524code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
5525``normal``.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005526
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005527The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a dominating ``catchpad``
5528instruction. The ``catchret`` destroys the physical frame established by
5529``catchpad``, so executing multiple returns on the same token without
5530re-executing the ``catchpad`` will result in undefined behavior.
5531See :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` for more details.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005532
5533Example:
5534""""""""
5535
5536.. code-block:: llvm
5537
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005538 catchret from %catch label %continue
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005539
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005540.. _i_cleanupret:
5541
5542'``cleanupret``' Instruction
5543^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5544
5545Syntax:
5546"""""""
5547
5548::
5549
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005550 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
5551 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005552
5553Overview:
5554"""""""""
5555
5556The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
5557an optional successor.
5558
5559
5560Arguments:
5561""""""""""
5562
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00005563The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
5564which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
5565It also has an optional successor, ``continue``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005566
5567Semantics:
5568""""""""""
5569
5570The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
5571:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
5572:ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
5573It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005574
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005575The unwind destination ``continue``, if present, must be an EH pad
5576whose parent is either ``none`` or an ancestor of the ``cleanuppad``
5577being returned from. This constitutes an exceptional exit from all
5578ancestors of the completed ``cleanuppad``, up to but not including
5579the parent of ``continue``.
5580See :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` for more details.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005581
5582Example:
5583""""""""
5584
5585.. code-block:: llvm
5586
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005587 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
5588 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005589
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005590.. _i_unreachable:
5591
5592'``unreachable``' Instruction
5593^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5594
5595Syntax:
5596"""""""
5597
5598::
5599
5600 unreachable
5601
5602Overview:
5603"""""""""
5604
5605The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
5606instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
5607the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
5608after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
5609
5610Semantics:
5611""""""""""
5612
5613The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
5614
5615.. _binaryops:
5616
5617Binary Operations
5618-----------------
5619
5620Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
5621They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
5622them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
5623data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
5624result value has the same type as its operands.
5625
5626There are several different binary operators:
5627
5628.. _i_add:
5629
5630'``add``' Instruction
5631^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5632
5633Syntax:
5634"""""""
5635
5636::
5637
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005638 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5639 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5640 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5641 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005642
5643Overview:
5644"""""""""
5645
5646The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5647
5648Arguments:
5649""""""""""
5650
5651The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
5652:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5653arguments must have identical types.
5654
5655Semantics:
5656""""""""""
5657
5658The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
5659
5660If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5661mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5662the result.
5663
5664Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5665instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5666
5667``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5668respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5669result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5670unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5671
5672Example:
5673""""""""
5674
5675.. code-block:: llvm
5676
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005677 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005678
5679.. _i_fadd:
5680
5681'``fadd``' Instruction
5682^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5683
5684Syntax:
5685"""""""
5686
5687::
5688
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005689 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005690
5691Overview:
5692"""""""""
5693
5694The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5695
5696Arguments:
5697""""""""""
5698
5699The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5700point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5701Both arguments must have identical types.
5702
5703Semantics:
5704""""""""""
5705
5706The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This
5707instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`,
5708which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point
5709optimizations:
5710
5711Example:
5712""""""""
5713
5714.. code-block:: llvm
5715
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005716 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005717
5718'``sub``' Instruction
5719^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5720
5721Syntax:
5722"""""""
5723
5724::
5725
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005726 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5727 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5728 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5729 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005730
5731Overview:
5732"""""""""
5733
5734The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5735
5736Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
5737instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5738
5739Arguments:
5740""""""""""
5741
5742The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
5743:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5744arguments must have identical types.
5745
5746Semantics:
5747""""""""""
5748
5749The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
5750
5751If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5752mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5753the result.
5754
5755Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5756instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5757
5758``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5759respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5760result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5761unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5762
5763Example:
5764""""""""
5765
5766.. code-block:: llvm
5767
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005768 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
5769 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005770
5771.. _i_fsub:
5772
5773'``fsub``' Instruction
5774^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5775
5776Syntax:
5777"""""""
5778
5779::
5780
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005781 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005782
5783Overview:
5784"""""""""
5785
5786The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5787
5788Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
5789instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5790
5791Arguments:
5792""""""""""
5793
5794The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5795point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5796Both arguments must have identical types.
5797
5798Semantics:
5799""""""""""
5800
5801The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands.
5802This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5803flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5804unsafe floating point optimizations:
5805
5806Example:
5807""""""""
5808
5809.. code-block:: llvm
5810
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005811 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
5812 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005813
5814'``mul``' Instruction
5815^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5816
5817Syntax:
5818"""""""
5819
5820::
5821
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005822 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5823 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5824 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5825 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005826
5827Overview:
5828"""""""""
5829
5830The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
5831
5832Arguments:
5833""""""""""
5834
5835The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
5836:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5837arguments must have identical types.
5838
5839Semantics:
5840""""""""""
5841
5842The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
5843
5844If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
5845returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
5846bit width of the result.
5847
5848Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
5849result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
5850correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
5851(e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
5852sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
5853product.
5854
5855``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5856respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5857result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5858unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5859
5860Example:
5861""""""""
5862
5863.. code-block:: llvm
5864
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005865 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005866
5867.. _i_fmul:
5868
5869'``fmul``' Instruction
5870^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5871
5872Syntax:
5873"""""""
5874
5875::
5876
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005877 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005878
5879Overview:
5880"""""""""
5881
5882The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
5883
5884Arguments:
5885""""""""""
5886
5887The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5888point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5889Both arguments must have identical types.
5890
5891Semantics:
5892""""""""""
5893
5894The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands.
5895This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5896flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5897unsafe floating point optimizations:
5898
5899Example:
5900""""""""
5901
5902.. code-block:: llvm
5903
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005904 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005905
5906'``udiv``' Instruction
5907^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5908
5909Syntax:
5910"""""""
5911
5912::
5913
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005914 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5915 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005916
5917Overview:
5918"""""""""
5919
5920The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
5921
5922Arguments:
5923""""""""""
5924
5925The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
5926:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5927arguments must have identical types.
5928
5929Semantics:
5930""""""""""
5931
5932The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
5933
5934Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
5935distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
5936
5937Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
5938
5939If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
5940a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
5941such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
5942
5943Example:
5944""""""""
5945
5946.. code-block:: llvm
5947
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005948 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005949
5950'``sdiv``' Instruction
5951^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5952
5953Syntax:
5954"""""""
5955
5956::
5957
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005958 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5959 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005960
5961Overview:
5962"""""""""
5963
5964The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
5965
5966Arguments:
5967""""""""""
5968
5969The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
5970:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5971arguments must have identical types.
5972
5973Semantics:
5974""""""""""
5975
5976The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
5977rounded towards zero.
5978
5979Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
5980distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
5981
5982Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to
5983undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by
5984doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
5985
5986If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
5987a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
5988
5989Example:
5990""""""""
5991
5992.. code-block:: llvm
5993
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005994 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005995
5996.. _i_fdiv:
5997
5998'``fdiv``' Instruction
5999^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6000
6001Syntax:
6002"""""""
6003
6004::
6005
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006006 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006007
6008Overview:
6009"""""""""
6010
6011The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6012
6013Arguments:
6014""""""""""
6015
6016The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
6017point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
6018Both arguments must have identical types.
6019
6020Semantics:
6021""""""""""
6022
6023The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands.
6024This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6025flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6026unsafe floating point optimizations:
6027
6028Example:
6029""""""""
6030
6031.. code-block:: llvm
6032
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006033 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006034
6035'``urem``' Instruction
6036^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6037
6038Syntax:
6039"""""""
6040
6041::
6042
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006043 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006044
6045Overview:
6046"""""""""
6047
6048The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
6049division of its two arguments.
6050
6051Arguments:
6052""""""""""
6053
6054The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
6055:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6056arguments must have identical types.
6057
6058Semantics:
6059""""""""""
6060
6061This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
6062This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
6063remainder.
6064
6065Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
6066distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
6067
6068Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
6069
6070Example:
6071""""""""
6072
6073.. code-block:: llvm
6074
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006075 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006076
6077'``srem``' Instruction
6078^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6079
6080Syntax:
6081"""""""
6082
6083::
6084
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006085 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006086
6087Overview:
6088"""""""""
6089
6090The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
6091division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
6092:ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
6093must be integers.
6094
6095Arguments:
6096""""""""""
6097
6098The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
6099:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6100arguments must have identical types.
6101
6102Semantics:
6103""""""""""
6104
6105This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
6106is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
6107*modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
6108as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
6109difference, see `The Math
6110Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
6111table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
6112`Wikipedia: modulo
6113operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
6114
6115Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
6116distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
6117
6118Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
6119Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
6120occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
6121-2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
6122rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
6123result of the division and the remainder.)
6124
6125Example:
6126""""""""
6127
6128.. code-block:: llvm
6129
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006130 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006131
6132.. _i_frem:
6133
6134'``frem``' Instruction
6135^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6136
6137Syntax:
6138"""""""
6139
6140::
6141
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006142 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006143
6144Overview:
6145"""""""""
6146
6147The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
6148its two operands.
6149
6150Arguments:
6151""""""""""
6152
6153The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
6154point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
6155Both arguments must have identical types.
6156
6157Semantics:
6158""""""""""
6159
6160This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division. The remainder
6161has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any
6162number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints
6163to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
6164
6165Example:
6166""""""""
6167
6168.. code-block:: llvm
6169
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006170 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006171
6172.. _bitwiseops:
6173
6174Bitwise Binary Operations
6175-------------------------
6176
6177Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
6178in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
6179commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
6180operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
6181single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
6182
6183'``shl``' Instruction
6184^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6185
6186Syntax:
6187"""""""
6188
6189::
6190
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006191 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6192 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6193 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6194 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006195
6196Overview:
6197"""""""""
6198
6199The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
6200a specified number of bits.
6201
6202Arguments:
6203""""""""""
6204
6205Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
6206:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6207'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6208
6209Semantics:
6210""""""""""
6211
6212The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
6213where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
Sean Silvab8a108c2015-04-17 21:58:55 +00006214dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006215``op1``, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each
6216vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount
6217in ``op2``.
6218
6219If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6220value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the
6221``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6222value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the
6223resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they
6224would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same
6225nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)).
6226
6227Example:
6228""""""""
6229
6230.. code-block:: llvm
6231
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006232 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
6233 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
6234 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006235 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6236 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
6237
6238'``lshr``' Instruction
6239^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6240
6241Syntax:
6242"""""""
6243
6244::
6245
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006246 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6247 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006248
6249Overview:
6250"""""""""
6251
6252The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
6253operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
6254
6255Arguments:
6256""""""""""
6257
6258Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
6259:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6260'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6261
6262Semantics:
6263""""""""""
6264
6265This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
6266most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
6267the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6268than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6269arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6270corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6271
6272If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
6273a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6274non-zero.
6275
6276Example:
6277""""""""
6278
6279.. code-block:: llvm
6280
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006281 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6282 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6283 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6284 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006285 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6286 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
6287
6288'``ashr``' Instruction
6289^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6290
6291Syntax:
6292"""""""
6293
6294::
6295
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006296 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6297 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006298
6299Overview:
6300"""""""""
6301
6302The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
6303operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
6304extension.
6305
6306Arguments:
6307""""""""""
6308
6309Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
6310:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6311'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6312
6313Semantics:
6314""""""""""
6315
6316This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
6317The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
6318of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6319than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6320arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6321corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6322
6323If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
6324a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6325non-zero.
6326
6327Example:
6328""""""""
6329
6330.. code-block:: llvm
6331
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006332 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6333 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6334 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6335 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006336 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6337 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
6338
6339'``and``' Instruction
6340^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6341
6342Syntax:
6343"""""""
6344
6345::
6346
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006347 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006348
6349Overview:
6350"""""""""
6351
6352The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
6353operands.
6354
6355Arguments:
6356""""""""""
6357
6358The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
6359:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6360arguments must have identical types.
6361
6362Semantics:
6363""""""""""
6364
6365The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
6366
6367+-----+-----+-----+
6368| In0 | In1 | Out |
6369+-----+-----+-----+
6370| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6371+-----+-----+-----+
6372| 0 | 1 | 0 |
6373+-----+-----+-----+
6374| 1 | 0 | 0 |
6375+-----+-----+-----+
6376| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6377+-----+-----+-----+
6378
6379Example:
6380""""""""
6381
6382.. code-block:: llvm
6383
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006384 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
6385 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
6386 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006387
6388'``or``' Instruction
6389^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6390
6391Syntax:
6392"""""""
6393
6394::
6395
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006396 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006397
6398Overview:
6399"""""""""
6400
6401The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
6402two operands.
6403
6404Arguments:
6405""""""""""
6406
6407The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
6408:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6409arguments must have identical types.
6410
6411Semantics:
6412""""""""""
6413
6414The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
6415
6416+-----+-----+-----+
6417| In0 | In1 | Out |
6418+-----+-----+-----+
6419| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6420+-----+-----+-----+
6421| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6422+-----+-----+-----+
6423| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6424+-----+-----+-----+
6425| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6426+-----+-----+-----+
6427
6428Example:
6429""""""""
6430
6431::
6432
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006433 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
6434 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
6435 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006436
6437'``xor``' Instruction
6438^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6439
6440Syntax:
6441"""""""
6442
6443::
6444
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006445 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006446
6447Overview:
6448"""""""""
6449
6450The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
6451its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
6452complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
6453
6454Arguments:
6455""""""""""
6456
6457The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
6458:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6459arguments must have identical types.
6460
6461Semantics:
6462""""""""""
6463
6464The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
6465
6466+-----+-----+-----+
6467| In0 | In1 | Out |
6468+-----+-----+-----+
6469| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6470+-----+-----+-----+
6471| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6472+-----+-----+-----+
6473| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6474+-----+-----+-----+
6475| 1 | 1 | 0 |
6476+-----+-----+-----+
6477
6478Example:
6479""""""""
6480
6481.. code-block:: llvm
6482
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006483 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
6484 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
6485 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
6486 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006487
6488Vector Operations
6489-----------------
6490
6491LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
6492target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
6493and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
6494While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
6495sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
6496take full advantage of a specific target.
6497
6498.. _i_extractelement:
6499
6500'``extractelement``' Instruction
6501^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6502
6503Syntax:
6504"""""""
6505
6506::
6507
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006508 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006509
6510Overview:
6511"""""""""
6512
6513The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
6514from a vector at a specified index.
6515
6516Arguments:
6517""""""""""
6518
6519The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
6520:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
6521the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006522variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006523
6524Semantics:
6525""""""""""
6526
6527The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
6528Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
6529exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined.
6530
6531Example:
6532""""""""
6533
6534.. code-block:: llvm
6535
6536 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
6537
6538.. _i_insertelement:
6539
6540'``insertelement``' Instruction
6541^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6542
6543Syntax:
6544"""""""
6545
6546::
6547
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006548 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006549
6550Overview:
6551"""""""""
6552
6553The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
6554vector at a specified index.
6555
6556Arguments:
6557""""""""""
6558
6559The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
6560:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
6561type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
6562is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006563index may be a variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006564
6565Semantics:
6566""""""""""
6567
6568The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
6569are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
6570``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are
6571undefined.
6572
6573Example:
6574""""""""
6575
6576.. code-block:: llvm
6577
6578 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
6579
6580.. _i_shufflevector:
6581
6582'``shufflevector``' Instruction
6583^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6584
6585Syntax:
6586"""""""
6587
6588::
6589
6590 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
6591
6592Overview:
6593"""""""""
6594
6595The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
6596from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
6597the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
6598
6599Arguments:
6600""""""""""
6601
6602The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
6603with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
6604type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
6605length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
6606same as the element type of the first two operands.
6607
6608The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
6609constant integer or undef values.
6610
6611Semantics:
6612""""""""""
6613
6614The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
6615across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
6616element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
6617result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't
6618care") and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from
6619only one vector.
6620
6621Example:
6622""""""""
6623
6624.. code-block:: llvm
6625
6626 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6627 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
6628 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
6629 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
6630 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
6631 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
6632 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6633 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
6634
6635Aggregate Operations
6636--------------------
6637
6638LLVM supports several instructions for working with
6639:ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
6640
6641.. _i_extractvalue:
6642
6643'``extractvalue``' Instruction
6644^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6645
6646Syntax:
6647"""""""
6648
6649::
6650
6651 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
6652
6653Overview:
6654"""""""""
6655
6656The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
6657from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6658
6659Arguments:
6660""""""""""
6661
6662The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
Arch D. Robisona7f8f252015-10-14 19:10:45 +00006663:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006664constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
6665as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
6666
6667The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
6668
6669- Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
6670 omitted and assumed to be zero.
6671- At least one index must be specified.
6672- Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
6673
6674Semantics:
6675""""""""""
6676
6677The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
6678the index operands.
6679
6680Example:
6681""""""""
6682
6683.. code-block:: llvm
6684
6685 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
6686
6687.. _i_insertvalue:
6688
6689'``insertvalue``' Instruction
6690^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6691
6692Syntax:
6693"""""""
6694
6695::
6696
6697 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
6698
6699Overview:
6700"""""""""
6701
6702The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
6703an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6704
6705Arguments:
6706""""""""""
6707
6708The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
6709:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
6710a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
6711indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
6712similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
6713to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
6714indices.
6715
6716Semantics:
6717""""""""""
6718
6719The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
6720that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
6721indices is that of ``elt``.
6722
6723Example:
6724""""""""
6725
6726.. code-block:: llvm
6727
6728 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
6729 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
Dan Liewffcfe7f2014-09-08 21:19:46 +00006730 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006731
6732.. _memoryops:
6733
6734Memory Access and Addressing Operations
6735---------------------------------------
6736
6737A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
6738memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
6739very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
6740memory in LLVM.
6741
6742.. _i_alloca:
6743
6744'``alloca``' Instruction
6745^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6746
6747Syntax:
6748"""""""
6749
6750::
6751
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006752 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] ; yields type*:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006753
6754Overview:
6755"""""""""
6756
6757The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
6758currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
6759function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
6760generic address space (address space zero).
6761
6762Arguments:
6763""""""""""
6764
6765The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
6766bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
6767appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
6768the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
6769to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006770allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
6771alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
6772zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
6773boundary compatible with the type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006774
6775'``type``' may be any sized type.
6776
6777Semantics:
6778""""""""""
6779
6780Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
6781if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
6782memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
6783'``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
6784variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
6785(either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
6786reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
6787The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
6788is not specified.
6789
6790Example:
6791""""""""
6792
6793.. code-block:: llvm
6794
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006795 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6796 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
6797 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
6798 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006799
6800.. _i_load:
6801
6802'``load``' Instruction
6803^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6804
6805Syntax:
6806"""""""
6807
6808::
6809
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00006810 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00006811 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006812 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00006813 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00006814 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006815
6816Overview:
6817"""""""""
6818
6819The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
6820
6821Arguments:
6822""""""""""
6823
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00006824The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00006825from which to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006826class <t_firstclass>` type. If the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``,
6827then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
6828execution of this ``load`` with other :ref:`volatile
6829operations <volatile>`.
6830
6831If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra
6832:ref:`ordering <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The
6833``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load``
6834instructions. Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results
6835when they may see multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must
6836be an integer type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or
6837equal to eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit.
6838``align`` must be explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has
6839undefined behavior if the alignment is not set to a value which is at
6840least the size in bytes of the pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have
6841any defined semantics for atomic loads.
6842
6843The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
6844operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00006845or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006846alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
6847to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
6848alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006849may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
6850maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006851
6852The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006853metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006854``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006855metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006856that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
6857generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
6858as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
6859
6860The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006861metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
6862entries. The existence of the ``!invariant.load`` metadata on the
Philip Reamese1526fc2014-11-24 22:32:43 +00006863instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address
6864operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged.
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00006865Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable,
6866but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable
6867its value is henceforth unchanging.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006868
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00006869The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
6870 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
6871
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00006872The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
6873metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
6874entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
6875instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
Piotr Padlewskid97846e2015-09-02 20:33:16 +00006876never be null. This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00006877on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00006878to loads of a pointer type.
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00006879
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00006880The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
6881name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00006882entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006883tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00006884The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
6885value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
6886attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006887to loads of a pointer type.
6888
6889The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00006890metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
6891``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006892instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
6893dereferenceable or null.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00006894The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
6895value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
6896attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006897to loads of a pointer type.
6898
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00006899The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
6900``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
6901The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
6902optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
6903by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
6904This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
6905This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
6906
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006907Semantics:
6908""""""""""
6909
6910The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
6911is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
6912minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
6913example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
6914value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
6915of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
6916written using a store of the same type.
6917
6918Examples:
6919"""""""""
6920
6921.. code-block:: llvm
6922
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006923 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6924 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00006925 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006926
6927.. _i_store:
6928
6929'``store``' Instruction
6930^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6931
6932Syntax:
6933"""""""
6934
6935::
6936
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00006937 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
6938 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006939
6940Overview:
6941"""""""""
6942
6943The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
6944
6945Arguments:
6946""""""""""
6947
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006948There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store
6949and an address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006950operand must be a pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006951the ``<value>`` operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006952then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
6953execution of this ``store`` with other :ref:`volatile
6954operations <volatile>`.
6955
6956If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra
6957:ref:`ordering <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The
6958``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store``
6959instructions. Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results
6960when they may see multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must
6961be an integer type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or
6962equal to eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit.
6963``align`` must be explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store
6964has undefined behavior if the alignment is not set to a value which is
6965at least the size in bytes of the pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not
6966have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
6967
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006968The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006969operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006970or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006971alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
6972to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006973alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006974alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006975safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006976
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006977The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006978name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006979value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006980tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
6981be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
6982instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the MOVNT instruction on
6983x86.
6984
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00006985The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
6986single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
6987
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006988Semantics:
6989""""""""""
6990
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006991The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
6992location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006993of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
6994minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
6995example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
6996value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
6997of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
6998belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
6999
7000Example:
7001""""""""
7002
7003.. code-block:: llvm
7004
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007005 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7006 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
Nick Lewycky149d04c2015-08-11 01:05:16 +00007007 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007008
7009.. _i_fence:
7010
7011'``fence``' Instruction
7012^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7013
7014Syntax:
7015"""""""
7016
7017::
7018
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007019 fence [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007020
7021Overview:
7022"""""""""
7023
7024The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
7025between operations.
7026
7027Arguments:
7028""""""""""
7029
7030'``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
7031defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
7032``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
7033
7034Semantics:
7035""""""""""
7036
7037A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
7038*synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
7039semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
7040operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
7041modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
7042headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
7043*happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
7044``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
7045provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
7046still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
7047*happens-before* edge.
7048
7049A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
7050``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
7051the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
7052
7053The optional ":ref:`singlethread <singlethread>`" argument specifies
7054that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread.
7055(This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.)
7056
7057Example:
7058""""""""
7059
7060.. code-block:: llvm
7061
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007062 fence acquire ; yields void
7063 fence singlethread seq_cst ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007064
7065.. _i_cmpxchg:
7066
7067'``cmpxchg``' Instruction
7068^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7069
7070Syntax:
7071"""""""
7072
7073::
7074
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007075 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007076
7077Overview:
7078"""""""""
7079
7080The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
7081loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007082equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007083
7084Arguments:
7085""""""""""
7086
7087There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
7088to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
7089address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
7090are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer type whose bit width
7091is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal
7092to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must have the same
7093type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to that type. If the
7094``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed
7095to modify the number or order of execution of this ``cmpxchg`` with
7096other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
7097
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007098The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
Tim Northover1dcc9f92014-06-13 14:24:16 +00007099``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
7100must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
7101stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
7102``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007103
7104The optional "``singlethread``" argument declares that the ``cmpxchg``
7105is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in
7106the same thread as the ``cmpxchg``. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with
7107respect to all other code in the system.
7108
7109The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
7110equal to the size in memory of the operand.
7111
7112Semantics:
7113""""""""""
7114
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007115The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
7116is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the read value is the equal, the
7117'``<new>``' is written. The original value at the location is returned, together
7118with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
7119
7120If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
7121permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
7122matched.
7123
7124If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
7125if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007126
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007127A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
7128identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
7129load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007130
7131Example:
7132""""""""
7133
7134.. code-block:: llvm
7135
7136 entry:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00007137 %orig = atomic load i32, i32* %ptr unordered ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007138 br label %loop
7139
7140 loop:
7141 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%old, %loop]
7142 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007143 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007144 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
7145 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007146 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
7147
7148 done:
7149 ...
7150
7151.. _i_atomicrmw:
7152
7153'``atomicrmw``' Instruction
7154^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7155
7156Syntax:
7157"""""""
7158
7159::
7160
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007161 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields ty
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007162
7163Overview:
7164"""""""""
7165
7166The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
7167
7168Arguments:
7169""""""""""
7170
7171There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
7172operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
7173operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
7174
7175- xchg
7176- add
7177- sub
7178- and
7179- nand
7180- or
7181- xor
7182- max
7183- min
7184- umax
7185- umin
7186
7187The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
7188of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
7189target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
7190be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
7191``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
7192order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
7193operations <volatile>`.
7194
7195Semantics:
7196""""""""""
7197
7198The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
7199operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
7200value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
7201operation argument:
7202
7203- xchg: ``*ptr = val``
7204- add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
7205- sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
7206- and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
7207- nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
7208- or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
7209- xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
7210- max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7211- min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7212- umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7213 comparison)
7214- umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7215 comparison)
7216
7217Example:
7218""""""""
7219
7220.. code-block:: llvm
7221
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007222 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007223
7224.. _i_getelementptr:
7225
7226'``getelementptr``' Instruction
7227^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7228
7229Syntax:
7230"""""""
7231
7232::
7233
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007234 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7235 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7236 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007237
7238Overview:
7239"""""""""
7240
7241The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
7242subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007243address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
7244be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007245
7246Arguments:
7247""""""""""
7248
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007249The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
7250The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
7251base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007252that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
7253The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
7254into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
7255first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
7256(not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
7257can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
7258value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
7259subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
7260would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
7261
7262The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
7263When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
7264**constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
7265be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
7266pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
7267required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
7268where relevant.
7269
7270For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
7271to LLVM:
7272
7273.. code-block:: c
7274
7275 struct RT {
7276 char A;
7277 int B[10][20];
7278 char C;
7279 };
7280 struct ST {
7281 int X;
7282 double Y;
7283 struct RT Z;
7284 };
7285
7286 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
7287 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
7288 }
7289
7290The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
7291
7292.. code-block:: llvm
7293
7294 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
7295 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
7296
7297 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
7298 entry:
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007299 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007300 ret i32* %arrayidx
7301 }
7302
7303Semantics:
7304""""""""""
7305
7306In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
7307'``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
7308= '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
7309indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
7310'``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
7311structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
7312structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
7313dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
7314type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
7315element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
7316
7317Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
7318returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
7319for the given testcase is equivalent to:
7320
7321.. code-block:: llvm
7322
7323 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007324 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
7325 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
7326 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
7327 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
7328 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007329 ret i32* %t5
7330 }
7331
7332If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
7333``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
7334pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
7335of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
7336offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
7337precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
7338allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
7339all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
7340past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the
7341``inbounds`` keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise.
7342
7343If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
7344base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
7345offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
7346or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
7347``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
7348pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
7349though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
7350:ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
7351information.
7352
7353The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
7354into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
7355
7356Example:
7357""""""""
7358
7359.. code-block:: llvm
7360
7361 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007362 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007363 ; yields i8*:vptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007364 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007365 ; yields i8*:eptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007366 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007367 ; yields i32*:iptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007368 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007369
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007370Vector of pointers:
7371"""""""""""""""""""
7372
7373The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
7374when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
7375arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
7376will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007377
7378.. code-block:: llvm
7379
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007380 ; All arguments are vectors:
7381 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7382 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007383
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007384 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
7385 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
7386 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007387
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007388 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
7389 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7390 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007391
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007392 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
7393
7394The two following instructions are equivalent:
7395
7396.. code-block:: llvm
7397
7398 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7399 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
7400 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
7401 <4 x i32> %ind4,
7402 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007403
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007404 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7405 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
7406
7407Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
7408makes sense:
7409
7410.. code-block:: c
7411
7412 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
7413 double *A, B; int *C;
7414 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
7415 A[i] = B[C[i]];
7416 }
7417
7418.. code-block:: llvm
7419
7420 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
7421 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
7422 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
7423 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
7424 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007425
7426Conversion Operations
7427---------------------
7428
7429The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
7430(casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
7431various bit conversions on the operand.
7432
7433'``trunc .. to``' Instruction
7434^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7435
7436Syntax:
7437"""""""
7438
7439::
7440
7441 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7442
7443Overview:
7444"""""""""
7445
7446The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
7447
7448Arguments:
7449""""""""""
7450
7451The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
7452it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
7453of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7454larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
7455types are not allowed.
7456
7457Semantics:
7458""""""""""
7459
7460The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
7461and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
7462be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
7463It will always truncate bits.
7464
7465Example:
7466""""""""
7467
7468.. code-block:: llvm
7469
7470 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
7471 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
7472 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
7473 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
7474
7475'``zext .. to``' Instruction
7476^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7477
7478Syntax:
7479"""""""
7480
7481::
7482
7483 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7484
7485Overview:
7486"""""""""
7487
7488The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
7489
7490Arguments:
7491""""""""""
7492
7493The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7494to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7495the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7496smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7497
7498Semantics:
7499""""""""""
7500
7501The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
7502until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7503
7504When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
7505
7506Example:
7507""""""""
7508
7509.. code-block:: llvm
7510
7511 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
7512 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
7513 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7514
7515'``sext .. to``' Instruction
7516^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7517
7518Syntax:
7519"""""""
7520
7521::
7522
7523 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7524
7525Overview:
7526"""""""""
7527
7528The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
7529
7530Arguments:
7531""""""""""
7532
7533The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7534to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7535the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7536smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7537
7538Semantics:
7539""""""""""
7540
7541The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
7542bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
7543of the type ``ty2``.
7544
7545When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
7546
7547Example:
7548""""""""
7549
7550.. code-block:: llvm
7551
7552 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
7553 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
7554 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7555
7556'``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
7557^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7558
7559Syntax:
7560"""""""
7561
7562::
7563
7564 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7565
7566Overview:
7567"""""""""
7568
7569The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7570
7571Arguments:
7572""""""""""
7573
7574The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7575value to cast and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
7576The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
7577implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
7578
7579Semantics:
7580""""""""""
7581
Dan Liew50456fb2015-09-03 18:43:56 +00007582The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007583:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating
Dan Liew50456fb2015-09-03 18:43:56 +00007584point <t_floating>` type. If the value cannot fit (i.e. overflows) within the
7585destination type, ``ty2``, then the results are undefined. If the cast produces
7586an inexact result, how rounding is performed (e.g. truncation, also known as
7587round to zero) is undefined.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007588
7589Example:
7590""""""""
7591
7592.. code-block:: llvm
7593
7594 %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float ; yields float:123.0
7595 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float ; yields undefined
7596
7597'``fpext .. to``' Instruction
7598^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7599
7600Syntax:
7601"""""""
7602
7603::
7604
7605 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7606
7607Overview:
7608"""""""""
7609
7610The '``fpext``' extends a floating point ``value`` to a larger floating
7611point value.
7612
7613Arguments:
7614""""""""""
7615
7616The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7617``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it
7618to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
7619
7620Semantics:
7621""""""""""
7622
7623The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
7624:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating
7625point <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
7626*no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
7627*no-op cast* for a floating point cast.
7628
7629Example:
7630""""""""
7631
7632.. code-block:: llvm
7633
7634 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
7635 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
7636
7637'``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
7638^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7639
7640Syntax:
7641"""""""
7642
7643::
7644
7645 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7646
7647Overview:
7648"""""""""
7649
7650The '``fptoui``' converts a floating point ``value`` to its unsigned
7651integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
7652
7653Arguments:
7654""""""""""
7655
7656The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7657scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7658cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7659``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7660type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7661
7662Semantics:
7663""""""""""
7664
7665The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7666point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7667unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7668are undefined.
7669
7670Example:
7671""""""""
7672
7673.. code-block:: llvm
7674
7675 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
7676 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7677 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7678
7679'``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
7680^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7681
7682Syntax:
7683"""""""
7684
7685::
7686
7687 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7688
7689Overview:
7690"""""""""
7691
7692The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7693``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7694
7695Arguments:
7696""""""""""
7697
7698The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7699scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7700cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7701``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7702type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7703
7704Semantics:
7705""""""""""
7706
7707The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7708point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7709signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7710are undefined.
7711
7712Example:
7713""""""""
7714
7715.. code-block:: llvm
7716
7717 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
7718 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7719 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7720
7721'``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
7722^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7723
7724Syntax:
7725"""""""
7726
7727::
7728
7729 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7730
7731Overview:
7732"""""""""
7733
7734The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
7735and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7736
7737Arguments:
7738""""""""""
7739
7740The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7741scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7742``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7743``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7744type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7745
7746Semantics:
7747""""""""""
7748
7749The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
7750integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
7751value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results
7752are undefined.
7753
7754Example:
7755""""""""
7756
7757.. code-block:: llvm
7758
7759 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7760 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
7761
7762'``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
7763^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7764
7765Syntax:
7766"""""""
7767
7768::
7769
7770 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7771
7772Overview:
7773"""""""""
7774
7775The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
7776converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7777
7778Arguments:
7779""""""""""
7780
7781The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7782scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7783``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7784``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7785type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7786
7787Semantics:
7788""""""""""
7789
7790The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
7791quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If
7792the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
7793undefined.
7794
7795Example:
7796""""""""
7797
7798.. code-block:: llvm
7799
7800 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7801 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
7802
7803.. _i_ptrtoint:
7804
7805'``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
7806^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7807
7808Syntax:
7809"""""""
7810
7811::
7812
7813 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7814
7815Overview:
7816"""""""""
7817
7818The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
7819pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
7820
7821Arguments:
7822""""""""""
7823
7824The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00007825a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007826type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
7827a vector of integers type.
7828
7829Semantics:
7830""""""""""
7831
7832The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
7833``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
7834truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
7835If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
7836``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
7837the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
7838change.
7839
7840Example:
7841""""""""
7842
7843.. code-block:: llvm
7844
7845 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
7846 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
7847 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
7848
7849.. _i_inttoptr:
7850
7851'``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
7852^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7853
7854Syntax:
7855"""""""
7856
7857::
7858
7859 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7860
7861Overview:
7862"""""""""
7863
7864The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
7865pointer type, ``ty2``.
7866
7867Arguments:
7868""""""""""
7869
7870The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
7871cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
7872type.
7873
7874Semantics:
7875""""""""""
7876
7877The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
7878applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
7879of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
7880pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
7881of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
7882nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
7883
7884Example:
7885""""""""
7886
7887.. code-block:: llvm
7888
7889 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
7890 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
7891 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
7892 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
7893
7894.. _i_bitcast:
7895
7896'``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
7897^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7898
7899Syntax:
7900"""""""
7901
7902::
7903
7904 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7905
7906Overview:
7907"""""""""
7908
7909The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
7910changing any bits.
7911
7912Arguments:
7913""""""""""
7914
7915The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7916non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00007917also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
7918bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00007919identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00007920also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
7921conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
7922long as they have the same size).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007923
7924Semantics:
7925""""""""""
7926
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00007927The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
7928is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
7929conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
7930to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
7931pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007932pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
7933To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
7934or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007935
7936Example:
7937""""""""
7938
7939.. code-block:: llvm
7940
7941 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
7942 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
7943 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
7944 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
7945
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007946.. _i_addrspacecast:
7947
7948'``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
7949^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7950
7951Syntax:
7952"""""""
7953
7954::
7955
7956 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
7957
7958Overview:
7959"""""""""
7960
7961The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
7962address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
7963
7964Arguments:
7965""""""""""
7966
7967The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
7968to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
7969address space.
7970
7971Semantics:
7972""""""""""
7973
7974The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
7975``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
Matt Arsenault54a2a172013-11-15 05:44:56 +00007976value modification, depending on the target and the address space
7977pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
7978performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007979conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
7980location.
7981
7982Example:
7983""""""""
7984
7985.. code-block:: llvm
7986
Matt Arsenault9c13dd02013-11-15 22:43:50 +00007987 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
7988 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
7989 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007990
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007991.. _otherops:
7992
7993Other Operations
7994----------------
7995
7996The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
7997which defy better classification.
7998
7999.. _i_icmp:
8000
8001'``icmp``' Instruction
8002^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8003
8004Syntax:
8005"""""""
8006
8007::
8008
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008009 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008010
8011Overview:
8012"""""""""
8013
8014The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
8015boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
8016pointer, or pointer vector operands.
8017
8018Arguments:
8019""""""""""
8020
8021The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8022the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
8023not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
8024
8025#. ``eq``: equal
8026#. ``ne``: not equal
8027#. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
8028#. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
8029#. ``ult``: unsigned less than
8030#. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
8031#. ``sgt``: signed greater than
8032#. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
8033#. ``slt``: signed less than
8034#. ``sle``: signed less or equal
8035
8036The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
8037:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
8038must also be identical types.
8039
8040Semantics:
8041""""""""""
8042
8043The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
8044code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
8045:ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
8046
8047#. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
8048 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8049#. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
8050 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8051#. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8052 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8053#. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8054 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8055#. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8056 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8057#. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8058 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8059#. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8060 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8061#. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8062 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8063#. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8064 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8065#. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8066 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8067
8068If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
8069are compared as if they were integers.
8070
8071If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
8072element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
8073as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
8074
8075Example:
8076""""""""
8077
8078.. code-block:: llvm
8079
8080 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8081 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
8082 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
8083 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8084 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8085 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8086
8087Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
8088``icmp`` instruction.
8089
8090.. _i_fcmp:
8091
8092'``fcmp``' Instruction
8093^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8094
8095Syntax:
8096"""""""
8097
8098::
8099
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008100 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008101
8102Overview:
8103"""""""""
8104
8105The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
8106values based on comparison of its operands.
8107
8108If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a
8109boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
8110
8111If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a
8112vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
8113compared.
8114
8115Arguments:
8116""""""""""
8117
8118The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8119the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
8120not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
8121
8122#. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
8123#. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
8124#. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
8125#. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
8126#. ``olt``: ordered and less than
8127#. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
8128#. ``one``: ordered and not equal
8129#. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
8130#. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
8131#. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
8132#. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
8133#. ``ult``: unordered or less than
8134#. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
8135#. ``une``: unordered or not equal
8136#. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
8137#. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
8138
8139*Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
8140that either operand may be a QNAN.
8141
8142Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating
8143point <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point
8144type. They must have identical types.
8145
8146Semantics:
8147""""""""""
8148
8149The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
8150condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
8151vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
8152always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
8153
8154#. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
8155#. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8156 is equal to ``op2``.
8157#. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8158 is greater than ``op2``.
8159#. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8160 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8161#. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8162 is less than ``op2``.
8163#. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8164 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8165#. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8166 is not equal to ``op2``.
8167#. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
8168#. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8169 equal to ``op2``.
8170#. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8171 greater than ``op2``.
8172#. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8173 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8174#. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8175 less than ``op2``.
8176#. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8177 less than or equal to ``op2``.
8178#. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8179 not equal to ``op2``.
8180#. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
8181#. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
8182
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008183The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
8184:ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
8185otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations.
8186
8187Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
8188only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
8189assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
8190``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``nsz``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
8191
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008192Example:
8193""""""""
8194
8195.. code-block:: llvm
8196
8197 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
8198 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8199 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8200 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
8201
8202Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
8203``fcmp`` instruction.
8204
8205.. _i_phi:
8206
8207'``phi``' Instruction
8208^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8209
8210Syntax:
8211"""""""
8212
8213::
8214
8215 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
8216
8217Overview:
8218"""""""""
8219
8220The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
8221graph representing the function.
8222
8223Arguments:
8224""""""""""
8225
8226The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
8227After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
8228arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
8229block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
8230the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
8231label arguments.
8232
8233There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
8234and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
8235block.
8236
8237For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
8238deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
8239the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
8240instruction's return value on the same edge).
8241
8242Semantics:
8243""""""""""
8244
8245At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
8246specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
8247executed just prior to the current block.
8248
8249Example:
8250""""""""
8251
8252.. code-block:: llvm
8253
8254 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
8255 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
8256 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
8257 br label %Loop
8258
8259.. _i_select:
8260
8261'``select``' Instruction
8262^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8263
8264Syntax:
8265"""""""
8266
8267::
8268
8269 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
8270
8271 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
8272
8273Overview:
8274"""""""""
8275
8276The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
Joerg Sonnenberger94321ec2014-03-26 15:30:21 +00008277condition, without IR-level branching.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008278
8279Arguments:
8280""""""""""
8281
8282The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
8283values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008284class <t_firstclass>` type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008285
8286Semantics:
8287""""""""""
8288
8289If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
8290the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
8291argument.
8292
8293If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
8294vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
8295
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008296If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
8297same size, then an entire vector is selected.
8298
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008299Example:
8300""""""""
8301
8302.. code-block:: llvm
8303
8304 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
8305
8306.. _i_call:
8307
8308'``call``' Instruction
8309^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8310
8311Syntax:
8312"""""""
8313
8314::
8315
Akira Hatanaka5cfcce122015-11-06 23:55:38 +00008316 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty> [<fnty>*] <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00008317 [ operand bundles ]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008318
8319Overview:
8320"""""""""
8321
8322The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
8323
8324Arguments:
8325""""""""""
8326
8327This instruction requires several arguments:
8328
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008329#. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008330 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
8331 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008332 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008333 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008334
8335 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
8336 recursive cycle in the call graph.
8337 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
8338 forwarded in place.
8339
8340 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008341 the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following additional
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008342 rules:
8343
8344 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
8345 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
8346 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
8347 produced by the call or void.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008348 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008349 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
8350 in address space.
8351 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
8352 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
8353 returned, and inalloca, must match.
Reid Kleckner83498642014-08-26 00:33:28 +00008354 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
8355 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
8356 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008357
8358 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
8359 the following conditions are met:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008360
8361 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
8362 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
8363 uses value of call or is void).
8364 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
8365 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
Alp Tokercf218752014-06-30 18:57:16 +00008366 - `Platform-specific constraints are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008367 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
8368
Akira Hatanaka5cfcce122015-11-06 23:55:38 +00008369#. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
8370 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
8371 call optimization from being performed on the call.
8372
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008373#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
8374 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
8375 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
8376 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
8377 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
8378#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
8379 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
8380 are valid here.
8381#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
8382 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
8383 ``void``.
8384#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to function value
8385 being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by
8386 this signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not
8387 varargs and if the function type does not return a pointer to a
8388 function.
8389#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
8390 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
8391 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
8392 to function value.
8393#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
8394 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
8395 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
8396 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
8397 extra arguments can be specified.
8398#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
8399 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
8400 attributes are valid here.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00008401#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008402
8403Semantics:
8404""""""""""
8405
8406The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
8407a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
8408values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
8409flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
8410return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
8411
8412Example:
8413""""""""
8414
8415.. code-block:: llvm
8416
8417 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
8418 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
8419 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8420 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8421 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
8422
8423 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008424 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008425 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
8426 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
8427 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
8428 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
8429
8430llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
8431the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
8432perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
8433This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
8434support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
8435
8436.. _i_va_arg:
8437
8438'``va_arg``' Instruction
8439^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8440
8441Syntax:
8442"""""""
8443
8444::
8445
8446 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
8447
8448Overview:
8449"""""""""
8450
8451The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
8452the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
8453the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
8454
8455Arguments:
8456""""""""""
8457
8458This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
8459argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
8460increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
8461type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
8462
8463Semantics:
8464""""""""""
8465
8466The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
8467from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
8468the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
8469handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
8470
8471It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
8472not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
8473function.
8474
8475``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
8476function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
8477
8478Example:
8479""""""""
8480
8481See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
8482
8483Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
8484targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
8485types on any target.
8486
8487.. _i_landingpad:
8488
8489'``landingpad``' Instruction
8490^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8491
8492Syntax:
8493"""""""
8494
8495::
8496
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008497 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
8498 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008499
8500 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
8501 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
8502
8503Overview:
8504"""""""""
8505
8506The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8507system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008508is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008509code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008510defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008511re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
8512
8513Arguments:
8514""""""""""
8515
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008516The optional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008517``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
8518
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008519A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008520contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
8521or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
8522clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
8523"``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
8524'``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
8525the ``cleanup`` flag.
8526
8527Semantics:
8528""""""""""
8529
8530The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008531:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008532therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
8533calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8534represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
8535
8536The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
8537``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
8538clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
8539When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8540the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
8541match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
8542unwinding continues further up the call stack.
8543
8544The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
8545
8546- A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
8547 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
8548- A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
8549 first non-PHI instruction.
8550- There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
8551 pad block.
8552- A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
8553 '``landingpad``' instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008554
8555Example:
8556""""""""
8557
8558.. code-block:: llvm
8559
8560 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008561 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008562 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8563 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008564 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008565 cleanup
8566 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008567 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008568 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8569 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
8570
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008571.. _i_cleanuppad:
8572
8573'``cleanuppad``' Instruction
8574^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8575
8576Syntax:
8577"""""""
8578
8579::
8580
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008581 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008582
8583Overview:
8584"""""""""
8585
8586The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8587system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
8588is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
8589transfer control to run cleanup actions.
8590The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
8591information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
8592execute the cleanup.
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00008593The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008594match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
8595The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
8596``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
8597this operand may be the token ``none``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008598
8599Arguments:
8600""""""""""
8601
8602The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
8603by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
8604
8605Semantics:
8606""""""""""
8607
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008608When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8609the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
8610``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00008611As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8612represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008613
8614The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
8615
8616- A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
8617 an exceptional instruction.
8618- A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
8619 first non-PHI instruction.
8620- There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
8621 cleanup block.
8622- A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
8623 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008624
8625Executing a ``cleanuppad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad.
8626The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways:
86271) explicitly via a ``cleanupret`` that consumes it. Executing such a ``cleanupret``
8628 is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet
8629 exited.
86302) implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller),
David Majnemerbbfc7212015-12-14 18:34:23 +00008631 or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +000086323) implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of
8633 the ``cleanuppad``. When the ``cleanuppad`` is exited in this manner, it is
8634 undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an
8635 ancestor of the ``cleanuppad`` being exited.
8636
8637It is undefined behavior for the ``cleanuppad`` to exit via an unwind edge which
8638does not transitively unwind to the same destination as a constituent
8639``cleanupret``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008640
8641Example:
8642""""""""
8643
8644.. code-block:: llvm
8645
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008646 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008647
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008648.. _intrinsics:
8649
8650Intrinsic Functions
8651===================
8652
8653LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
8654have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
8655restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
8656for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
8657transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
8658reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
8659
8660Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
8661prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
8662not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
8663functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
8664functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
8665to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
8666intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
8667are added that they be documented here.
8668
8669Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
8670represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
8671different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
8672different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
8673intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
8674argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
8675integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
8676previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
8677function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
8678of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
8679argument or the result.
8680
8681Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
8682types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
8683those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
8684whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
8685``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
8686integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
8687functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
8688``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
8689overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
8690type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
8691name suffix.
8692
8693To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
8694LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
8695
8696.. _int_varargs:
8697
8698Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
8699-------------------------------------
8700
8701Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
8702:ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
8703functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
8704defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
8705
8706All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
8707value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
8708does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
8709prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
8710
8711This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
8712variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
8713
8714.. code-block:: llvm
8715
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008716 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
8717 ; it is merely an i8*.
8718 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
8719
8720 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
8721 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
8722
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008723 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
8724 ; Initialize variable argument processing
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008725 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
8726 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008727 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
8728
8729 ; Read a single integer argument
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008730 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008731
8732 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
8733 %aq = alloca i8*
8734 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
8735 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
8736 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
8737
8738 ; Stop processing of arguments.
8739 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
8740 ret i32 %tmp
8741 }
8742
8743 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
8744 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
8745 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
8746
8747.. _int_va_start:
8748
8749'``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
8750^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8751
8752Syntax:
8753"""""""
8754
8755::
8756
Nick Lewycky04f6de02013-09-11 22:04:52 +00008757 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008758
8759Overview:
8760"""""""""
8761
8762The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
8763subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
8764
8765Arguments:
8766""""""""""
8767
8768The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
8769
8770Semantics:
8771""""""""""
8772
8773The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
8774available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
8775``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
8776to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
8777function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
8778to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
8779that out.
8780
8781'``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
8782^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8783
8784Syntax:
8785"""""""
8786
8787::
8788
8789 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
8790
8791Overview:
8792"""""""""
8793
8794The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
8795initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
8796
8797Arguments:
8798""""""""""
8799
8800The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
8801
8802Semantics:
8803""""""""""
8804
8805The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
8806available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
8807element to which the argument points. Calls to
8808:ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
8809:ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
8810``llvm.va_end``.
8811
8812.. _int_va_copy:
8813
8814'``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
8815^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8816
8817Syntax:
8818"""""""
8819
8820::
8821
8822 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
8823
8824Overview:
8825"""""""""
8826
8827The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
8828from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
8829
8830Arguments:
8831""""""""""
8832
8833The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
8834The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
8835
8836Semantics:
8837""""""""""
8838
8839The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
8840available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
8841``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
8842intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
8843arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
8844
8845Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
8846--------------------------------------
8847
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008848LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00008849(GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
8850calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008851intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
8852
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008853These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
8854stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
8855require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008856Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008857these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008858details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008859
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008860Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
8861^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8862
8863LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008864collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00008865to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008866:ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00008867differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008868<GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008869described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008870
8871.. _int_gcroot:
8872
8873'``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
8874^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8875
8876Syntax:
8877"""""""
8878
8879::
8880
8881 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
8882
8883Overview:
8884"""""""""
8885
8886The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
8887the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
8888
8889Arguments:
8890""""""""""
8891
8892The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
8893the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
8894a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
8895root.
8896
8897Semantics:
8898""""""""""
8899
8900At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
8901"ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
8902information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
8903The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
8904:ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
8905
8906.. _int_gcread:
8907
8908'``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
8909^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8910
8911Syntax:
8912"""""""
8913
8914::
8915
8916 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
8917
8918Overview:
8919"""""""""
8920
8921The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
8922locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
8923barriers.
8924
8925Arguments:
8926""""""""""
8927
8928The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
8929address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
8930pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
8931runtime (otherwise null).
8932
8933Semantics:
8934""""""""""
8935
8936The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
8937instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
8938the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
8939intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
8940algorithm <gc>`.
8941
8942.. _int_gcwrite:
8943
8944'``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
8945^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8946
8947Syntax:
8948"""""""
8949
8950::
8951
8952 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
8953
8954Overview:
8955"""""""""
8956
8957The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
8958locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
8959barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
8960
8961Arguments:
8962""""""""""
8963
8964The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
8965the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
8966Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
8967object, Obj may be null.
8968
8969Semantics:
8970""""""""""
8971
8972The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
8973instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
8974the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
8975intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
8976algorithm <gc>`.
8977
8978Code Generator Intrinsics
8979-------------------------
8980
8981These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
8982may only be implemented with code generator support.
8983
8984'``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
8985^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8986
8987Syntax:
8988"""""""
8989
8990::
8991
8992 declare i8 *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
8993
8994Overview:
8995"""""""""
8996
8997The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
8998target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
8999function or one of its callers.
9000
9001Arguments:
9002""""""""""
9003
9004The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9005address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
9006caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9007value.
9008
9009Semantics:
9010""""""""""
9011
9012The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9013indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9014cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9015be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9016used for debugging purposes.
9017
9018Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9019other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9020of the obvious source-language caller.
9021
9022'``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
9023^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9024
9025Syntax:
9026"""""""
9027
9028::
9029
9030 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
9031
9032Overview:
9033"""""""""
9034
9035The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
9036target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
9037
9038Arguments:
9039""""""""""
9040
9041The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9042frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
9043its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9044value.
9045
9046Semantics:
9047""""""""""
9048
9049The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9050indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9051cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9052be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9053used for debugging purposes.
9054
9055Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9056other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9057of the obvious source-language caller.
9058
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009059'``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009060^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9061
9062Syntax:
9063"""""""
9064
9065::
9066
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009067 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
9068 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009069
9070Overview:
9071"""""""""
9072
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009073The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
9074allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009075live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009076computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009077
9078Arguments:
9079""""""""""
9080
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009081All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
9082casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009083once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009084
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009085The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009086bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
9087generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
9088other modules.
9089
Reid Klecknerd5afc62f2015-07-07 23:23:03 +00009090The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
9091call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
9092is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
9093pointer in platform-specific ways.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009094
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009095The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
9096'``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009097
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009098Semantics:
9099""""""""""
9100
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009101These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
9102stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
9103'``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
9104child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
9105The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
9106the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
9107'``llvm.localrecover``'.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009108
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009109.. _int_read_register:
9110.. _int_write_register:
9111
9112'``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
9113^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9114
9115Syntax:
9116"""""""
9117
9118::
9119
9120 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
9121 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
9122 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
9123 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00009124 !0 = !{!"sp\00"}
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009125
9126Overview:
9127"""""""""
9128
9129The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
9130provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
9131the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
9132with the register being read.
9133
9134Semantics:
9135""""""""""
9136
9137The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
9138register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
9139the current value of the register, where possible.
9140
9141This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
9142to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
9143bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
9144
9145The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
9146register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
9147allocatable registers are not supported.
9148
9149Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
Tim Northover3b0846e2014-05-24 12:50:23 +00009150architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009151work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
9152registers.
9153
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009154.. _int_stacksave:
9155
9156'``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
9157^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9158
9159Syntax:
9160"""""""
9161
9162::
9163
9164 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
9165
9166Overview:
9167"""""""""
9168
9169The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
9170of the function stack, for use with
9171:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
9172implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
9173arrays in C99.
9174
9175Semantics:
9176""""""""""
9177
9178This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
9179:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
9180``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
9181``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
9182the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
9183practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
9184were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
9185
9186.. _int_stackrestore:
9187
9188'``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
9189^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9190
9191Syntax:
9192"""""""
9193
9194::
9195
9196 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
9197
9198Overview:
9199"""""""""
9200
9201The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
9202the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
9203:ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
9204useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
9205sized arrays in C99.
9206
9207Semantics:
9208""""""""""
9209
9210See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
9211
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +00009212.. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
9213
9214'``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
Yury Gribov81f3f152015-12-01 13:24:48 +00009215^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +00009216
9217Syntax:
9218"""""""
9219
9220::
9221
9222 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
9223 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
9224
9225 Overview:
9226 """""""""
9227
9228 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
9229 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
9230 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
9231 intendend for use in combination with
9232 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
9233 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
9234 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
9235
9236Semantics:
9237""""""""""
9238
9239 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
9240 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
9241 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
9242 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
9243 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
9244 complicated, because substracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
9245 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
9246
9247 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
9248 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
9249 compile-time-known constant value.
9250
9251 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
9252 must match the target's generic address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
9253
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009254'``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
9255^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9256
9257Syntax:
9258"""""""
9259
9260::
9261
9262 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
9263
9264Overview:
9265"""""""""
9266
9267The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
9268insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
9269Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
9270its performance characteristics.
9271
9272Arguments:
9273""""""""""
9274
9275``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
9276determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
9277``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
9278locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
9279specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
9280instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
9281arguments must be constant integers.
9282
9283Semantics:
9284""""""""""
9285
9286This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
9287particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
9288targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
9289the processor cache for better performance.
9290
9291'``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
9292^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9293
9294Syntax:
9295"""""""
9296
9297::
9298
9299 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
9300
9301Overview:
9302"""""""""
9303
9304The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
9305Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
9306method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
9307exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
9308guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
9309optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
9310optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
9311allow correlations of simulation runs.
9312
9313Arguments:
9314""""""""""
9315
9316``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
9317
9318Semantics:
9319""""""""""
9320
9321This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
9322that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
9323
9324'``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
9325^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9326
9327Syntax:
9328"""""""
9329
9330::
9331
9332 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
9333
9334Overview:
9335"""""""""
9336
9337The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
9338counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
9339targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
9340should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
9341order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
9342timings.
9343
9344Semantics:
9345""""""""""
9346
9347When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
9348memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
9349specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
9350is lowered to a constant 0.
9351
Tim Northoverbc933082013-05-23 19:11:20 +00009352Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
9353running at and the host platform.
9354
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009355'``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
9356^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9357
9358Syntax:
9359"""""""
9360
9361::
9362
9363 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
9364
9365Overview:
9366"""""""""
9367
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009368The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
9369in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
9370targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
9371flushes the instruction cache.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009372
9373Semantics:
9374""""""""""
9375
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009376On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
9377intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
Alp Toker16f98b22014-04-09 14:47:27 +00009378cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009379instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
9380privileges.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009381
Sean Silvad02bf3e2014-04-07 22:29:53 +00009382The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009383time library.
Renato Golin93010e62014-03-26 14:01:32 +00009384
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009385This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
9386of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009387
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +00009388'``llvm.instrprof_increment``' Intrinsic
9389^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9390
9391Syntax:
9392"""""""
9393
9394::
9395
9396 declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
9397 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
9398
9399Overview:
9400"""""""""
9401
9402The '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
9403frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
9404lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
9405program at runtime.
9406
9407Arguments:
9408""""""""""
9409
9410The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
9411name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
9412(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
9413
9414The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
9415of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
9416the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
9417error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
9418``instrprof_increment`` that refer to the same name.
9419
9420The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
9421be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
9422
9423Semantics:
9424""""""""""
9425
9426This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
9427cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
9428structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
9429format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
9430the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
9431
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +00009432'``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' Intrinsic
9433^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9434
9435Syntax:
9436"""""""
9437
9438::
9439
9440 declare void @llvm.instrprof_value_profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
9441 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
9442 i32 <index>)
9443
9444Overview:
9445"""""""""
9446
9447The '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
9448frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
9449lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
9450instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
9451
9452Arguments:
9453""""""""""
9454
9455The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
9456name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
9457(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
9458
9459The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
9460of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
9461is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
9462``llvm.instrprof_*`` that refer to the same name.
9463
9464The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
9465expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
9466fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
9467supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
9468``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
9469``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
9470index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
9471
9472Semantics:
9473""""""""""
9474
9475This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
9476should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
9477pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
9478``llvm.instrprof_value_profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
9479runtime library with proper arguments.
9480
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009481Standard C Library Intrinsics
9482-----------------------------
9483
9484LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
9485functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
9486information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
9487generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
9488
9489.. _int_memcpy:
9490
9491'``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
9492^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9493
9494Syntax:
9495"""""""
9496
9497This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
9498integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
9499support all bit widths however.
9500
9501::
9502
9503 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9504 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9505 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9506 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9507
9508Overview:
9509"""""""""
9510
9511The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9512source location to the destination location.
9513
9514Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
9515intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9516arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9517
9518Arguments:
9519""""""""""
9520
9521The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9522pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9523specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9524alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9525boolean indicating a volatile access.
9526
9527If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9528then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers
9529are aligned to that boundary.
9530
9531If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
9532a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9533very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9534
9535Semantics:
9536""""""""""
9537
9538The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9539source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
9540overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
9541to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009542argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009543
9544'``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
9545^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9546
9547Syntax:
9548"""""""
9549
9550This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
9551bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
9552bit widths however.
9553
9554::
9555
9556 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9557 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9558 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9559 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9560
9561Overview:
9562"""""""""
9563
9564The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
9565source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
9566'``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
9567overlap.
9568
9569Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
9570intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9571arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9572
9573Arguments:
9574""""""""""
9575
9576The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9577pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9578specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9579alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9580boolean indicating a volatile access.
9581
9582If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9583then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are
9584aligned to that boundary.
9585
9586If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
9587is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
9588not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9589
9590Semantics:
9591""""""""""
9592
9593The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9594source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
9595copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
9596aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009597otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009598
9599'``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
9600^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9601
9602Syntax:
9603"""""""
9604
9605This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
9606bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
9607support all bit widths.
9608
9609::
9610
9611 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9612 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9613 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9614 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9615
9616Overview:
9617"""""""""
9618
9619The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
9620particular byte value.
9621
9622Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
9623intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile
9624arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
9625
9626Arguments:
9627""""""""""
9628
9629The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
9630is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
9631integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
9632argument is the known alignment of the destination location.
9633
9634If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9635then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to
9636that boundary.
9637
9638If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
9639a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9640very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9641
9642Semantics:
9643""""""""""
9644
9645The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
9646at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to
9647some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009648it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009649
9650'``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
9651^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9652
9653Syntax:
9654"""""""
9655
9656This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
9657floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9658all types however.
9659
9660::
9661
9662 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
9663 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
9664 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9665 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
9666 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9667
9668Overview:
9669"""""""""
9670
9671The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
9672returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``' functions would. Unlike
9673``sqrt`` in libm, however, ``llvm.sqrt`` has undefined behavior for
9674negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization,
9675because there is no need to worry about errno being set).
9676``llvm.sqrt(-0.0)`` is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.
9677
9678Arguments:
9679""""""""""
9680
9681The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9682type.
9683
9684Semantics:
9685""""""""""
9686
9687This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a
9688nonnegative floating point number.
9689
9690'``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
9691^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9692
9693Syntax:
9694"""""""
9695
9696This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
9697floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9698all types however.
9699
9700::
9701
9702 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
9703 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
9704 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
9705 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9706 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9707
9708Overview:
9709"""""""""
9710
9711The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
9712specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
9713multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
9714used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
9715
9716Arguments:
9717""""""""""
9718
9719The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
9720raise to that power.
9721
9722Semantics:
9723""""""""""
9724
9725This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
9726unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
9727
9728'``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
9729^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9730
9731Syntax:
9732"""""""
9733
9734This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
9735floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9736all types however.
9737
9738::
9739
9740 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
9741 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
9742 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9743 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
9744 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9745
9746Overview:
9747"""""""""
9748
9749The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
9750
9751Arguments:
9752""""""""""
9753
9754The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9755type.
9756
9757Semantics:
9758""""""""""
9759
9760This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
9761same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
9762conditions in the same way.
9763
9764'``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
9765^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9766
9767Syntax:
9768"""""""
9769
9770This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
9771floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9772all types however.
9773
9774::
9775
9776 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
9777 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
9778 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9779 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
9780 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9781
9782Overview:
9783"""""""""
9784
9785The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
9786
9787Arguments:
9788""""""""""
9789
9790The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9791type.
9792
9793Semantics:
9794""""""""""
9795
9796This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
9797same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
9798conditions in the same way.
9799
9800'``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
9801^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9802
9803Syntax:
9804"""""""
9805
9806This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
9807floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9808all types however.
9809
9810::
9811
9812 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
9813 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
9814 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
9815 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
9816 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
9817
9818Overview:
9819"""""""""
9820
9821The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
9822specified (positive or negative) power.
9823
9824Arguments:
9825""""""""""
9826
9827The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value
9828to raise to that power.
9829
9830Semantics:
9831""""""""""
9832
9833This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
9834returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
9835handles error conditions in the same way.
9836
9837'``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
9838^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9839
9840Syntax:
9841"""""""
9842
9843This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
9844floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9845all types however.
9846
9847::
9848
9849 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
9850 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
9851 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9852 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
9853 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9854
9855Overview:
9856"""""""""
9857
9858The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics perform the exp function.
9859
9860Arguments:
9861""""""""""
9862
9863The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9864type.
9865
9866Semantics:
9867""""""""""
9868
9869This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
9870would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9871
9872'``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
9873^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9874
9875Syntax:
9876"""""""
9877
9878This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
9879floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9880all types however.
9881
9882::
9883
9884 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
9885 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
9886 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9887 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
9888 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9889
9890Overview:
9891"""""""""
9892
9893The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics perform the exp2 function.
9894
9895Arguments:
9896""""""""""
9897
9898The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9899type.
9900
9901Semantics:
9902""""""""""
9903
9904This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
9905would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9906
9907'``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
9908^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9909
9910Syntax:
9911"""""""
9912
9913This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
9914floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9915all types however.
9916
9917::
9918
9919 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
9920 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
9921 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9922 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
9923 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9924
9925Overview:
9926"""""""""
9927
9928The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics perform the log function.
9929
9930Arguments:
9931""""""""""
9932
9933The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9934type.
9935
9936Semantics:
9937""""""""""
9938
9939This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
9940would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9941
9942'``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
9943^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9944
9945Syntax:
9946"""""""
9947
9948This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
9949floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9950all types however.
9951
9952::
9953
9954 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
9955 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
9956 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9957 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
9958 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9959
9960Overview:
9961"""""""""
9962
9963The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics perform the log10 function.
9964
9965Arguments:
9966""""""""""
9967
9968The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9969type.
9970
9971Semantics:
9972""""""""""
9973
9974This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
9975would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9976
9977'``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
9978^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9979
9980Syntax:
9981"""""""
9982
9983This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
9984floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9985all types however.
9986
9987::
9988
9989 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
9990 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
9991 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9992 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
9993 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9994
9995Overview:
9996"""""""""
9997
9998The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics perform the log2 function.
9999
10000Arguments:
10001""""""""""
10002
10003The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10004type.
10005
10006Semantics:
10007""""""""""
10008
10009This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
10010would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10011
10012'``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
10013^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10014
10015Syntax:
10016"""""""
10017
10018This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
10019floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10020all types however.
10021
10022::
10023
10024 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
10025 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
10026 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
10027 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
10028 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
10029
10030Overview:
10031"""""""""
10032
10033The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add
10034operation.
10035
10036Arguments:
10037""""""""""
10038
10039The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10040type.
10041
10042Semantics:
10043""""""""""
10044
10045This function returns the same values as the libm ``fma`` functions
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000010046would, and does not set errno.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010047
10048'``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
10049^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10050
10051Syntax:
10052"""""""
10053
10054This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
10055floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10056all types however.
10057
10058::
10059
10060 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
10061 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010062 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010063 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010064 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010065
10066Overview:
10067"""""""""
10068
10069The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
10070operand.
10071
10072Arguments:
10073""""""""""
10074
10075The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10076type.
10077
10078Semantics:
10079""""""""""
10080
10081This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
10082would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10083
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010084'``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000010085^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010086
10087Syntax:
10088"""""""
10089
10090This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
10091floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10092all types however.
10093
10094::
10095
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000010096 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
10097 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
10098 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
10099 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
10100 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010101
10102Overview:
10103"""""""""
10104
10105The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
10106arguments.
10107
10108
10109Arguments:
10110""""""""""
10111
10112The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10113type.
10114
10115Semantics:
10116""""""""""
10117
10118Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's
10119fmin.
10120
10121If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
10122NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
10123returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
10124fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
10125
10126'``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000010127^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010128
10129Syntax:
10130"""""""
10131
10132This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
10133floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10134all types however.
10135
10136::
10137
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000010138 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
10139 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
10140 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
10141 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
10142 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010143
10144Overview:
10145"""""""""
10146
10147The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
10148arguments.
10149
10150
10151Arguments:
10152""""""""""
10153
10154The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10155type.
10156
10157Semantics:
10158""""""""""
10159Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's
10160fmax.
10161
10162If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
10163NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
10164returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
10165fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
10166
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +000010167'``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
10168^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10169
10170Syntax:
10171"""""""
10172
10173This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
10174floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10175all types however.
10176
10177::
10178
10179 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
10180 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
10181 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
10182 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
10183 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
10184
10185Overview:
10186"""""""""
10187
10188The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
10189first operand and the sign of the second operand.
10190
10191Arguments:
10192""""""""""
10193
10194The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10195type.
10196
10197Semantics:
10198""""""""""
10199
10200This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
10201functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10202
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010203'``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
10204^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10205
10206Syntax:
10207"""""""
10208
10209This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
10210floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10211all types however.
10212
10213::
10214
10215 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
10216 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
10217 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10218 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
10219 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10220
10221Overview:
10222"""""""""
10223
10224The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
10225
10226Arguments:
10227""""""""""
10228
10229The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10230type.
10231
10232Semantics:
10233""""""""""
10234
10235This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
10236would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10237
10238'``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
10239^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10240
10241Syntax:
10242"""""""
10243
10244This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
10245floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10246all types however.
10247
10248::
10249
10250 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
10251 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
10252 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10253 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
10254 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10255
10256Overview:
10257"""""""""
10258
10259The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
10260
10261Arguments:
10262""""""""""
10263
10264The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10265type.
10266
10267Semantics:
10268""""""""""
10269
10270This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
10271would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10272
10273'``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
10274^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10275
10276Syntax:
10277"""""""
10278
10279This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
10280floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10281all types however.
10282
10283::
10284
10285 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
10286 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
10287 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10288 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
10289 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10290
10291Overview:
10292"""""""""
10293
10294The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10295nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
10296
10297Arguments:
10298""""""""""
10299
10300The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10301type.
10302
10303Semantics:
10304""""""""""
10305
10306This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
10307would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10308
10309'``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
10310^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10311
10312Syntax:
10313"""""""
10314
10315This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
10316floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10317all types however.
10318
10319::
10320
10321 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
10322 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
10323 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10324 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
10325 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10326
10327Overview:
10328"""""""""
10329
10330The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10331nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
10332operand isn't an integer.
10333
10334Arguments:
10335""""""""""
10336
10337The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10338type.
10339
10340Semantics:
10341""""""""""
10342
10343This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
10344would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10345
10346'``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
10347^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10348
10349Syntax:
10350"""""""
10351
10352This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
10353floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10354all types however.
10355
10356::
10357
10358 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
10359 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
10360 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10361 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
10362 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10363
10364Overview:
10365"""""""""
10366
10367The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10368nearest integer.
10369
10370Arguments:
10371""""""""""
10372
10373The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10374type.
10375
10376Semantics:
10377""""""""""
10378
10379This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
10380functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10381
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000010382'``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
10383^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10384
10385Syntax:
10386"""""""
10387
10388This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
10389floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10390all types however.
10391
10392::
10393
10394 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
10395 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
10396 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10397 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
10398 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10399
10400Overview:
10401"""""""""
10402
10403The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10404nearest integer.
10405
10406Arguments:
10407""""""""""
10408
10409The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10410type.
10411
10412Semantics:
10413""""""""""
10414
10415This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
10416functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10417
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010418Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
10419---------------------------
10420
10421LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
10422operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
10423
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000010424'``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
Akira Hatanaka7f5562b2015-11-13 21:09:57 +000010425^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000010426
10427Syntax:
10428"""""""
10429
10430This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
10431integer type.
10432
10433::
10434
10435 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
10436 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
10437 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
10438
10439Overview:
10440"""""""""
10441
10442The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
10443bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b1234567`` becomes
10444``0b7654321``.
10445
10446Semantics:
10447""""""""""
10448
10449The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has bit
10450``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output.
10451
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010452'``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
10453^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10454
10455Syntax:
10456"""""""
10457
10458This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
10459integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
10460
10461::
10462
10463 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
10464 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
10465 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
10466
10467Overview:
10468"""""""""
10469
10470The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
10471values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
10472These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
10473target's native byte order.
10474
10475Semantics:
10476""""""""""
10477
10478The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
10479and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
10480intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
10481swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
10482returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
10483``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
10484concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
10485respectively).
10486
10487'``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
10488^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10489
10490Syntax:
10491"""""""
10492
10493This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
10494bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
10495support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10496
10497::
10498
10499 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
10500 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
10501 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
10502 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
10503 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
10504 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
10505
10506Overview:
10507"""""""""
10508
10509The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
10510in a value.
10511
10512Arguments:
10513""""""""""
10514
10515The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
10516integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
10517match the argument type.
10518
10519Semantics:
10520""""""""""
10521
10522The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
10523each element of a vector.
10524
10525'``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
10526^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10527
10528Syntax:
10529"""""""
10530
10531This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
10532integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
10533targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10534
10535::
10536
10537 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10538 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10539 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10540 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10541 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10542 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10543
10544Overview:
10545"""""""""
10546
10547The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10548leading zeros in a variable.
10549
10550Arguments:
10551""""""""""
10552
10553The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010554any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010555type must match the first argument type.
10556
10557The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10558the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10559defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10560defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10561now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10562
10563Semantics:
10564""""""""""
10565
10566The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
10567zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
10568``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
10569if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10570``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
10571
10572'``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
10573^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10574
10575Syntax:
10576"""""""
10577
10578This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
10579integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
10580support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10581
10582::
10583
10584 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10585 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10586 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10587 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10588 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10589 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10590
10591Overview:
10592"""""""""
10593
10594The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10595trailing zeros.
10596
10597Arguments:
10598""""""""""
10599
10600The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010601any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010602type must match the first argument type.
10603
10604The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10605the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10606defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10607defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10608now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10609
10610Semantics:
10611""""""""""
10612
10613The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
10614zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
10615then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
10616``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10617``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
10618
Philip Reames34843ae2015-03-05 05:55:55 +000010619.. _int_overflow:
10620
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010621Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
10622-----------------------------------
10623
10624LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations.
10625
10626'``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10627^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10628
10629Syntax:
10630"""""""
10631
10632This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
10633on any integer bit width.
10634
10635::
10636
10637 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10638 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10639 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10640
10641Overview:
10642"""""""""
10643
10644The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10645a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
10646occurred during the signed summation.
10647
10648Arguments:
10649""""""""""
10650
10651The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10652may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10653bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10654``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10655addition.
10656
10657Semantics:
10658""""""""""
10659
10660The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010661a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010662first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
10663of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
10664overflow.
10665
10666Examples:
10667"""""""""
10668
10669.. code-block:: llvm
10670
10671 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10672 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10673 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10674 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10675
10676'``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10677^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10678
10679Syntax:
10680"""""""
10681
10682This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
10683on any integer bit width.
10684
10685::
10686
10687 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10688 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10689 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10690
10691Overview:
10692"""""""""
10693
10694The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10695an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
10696occurred during the unsigned summation.
10697
10698Arguments:
10699""""""""""
10700
10701The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10702may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10703bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10704``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10705addition.
10706
10707Semantics:
10708""""""""""
10709
10710The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010711an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010712first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
10713bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
10714
10715Examples:
10716"""""""""
10717
10718.. code-block:: llvm
10719
10720 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10721 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10722 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10723 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
10724
10725'``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10726^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10727
10728Syntax:
10729"""""""
10730
10731This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
10732on any integer bit width.
10733
10734::
10735
10736 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10737 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10738 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10739
10740Overview:
10741"""""""""
10742
10743The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10744a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10745overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
10746
10747Arguments:
10748""""""""""
10749
10750The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10751may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10752bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10753``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10754subtraction.
10755
10756Semantics:
10757""""""""""
10758
10759The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010760a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010761first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
10762which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
10763overflow.
10764
10765Examples:
10766"""""""""
10767
10768.. code-block:: llvm
10769
10770 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10771 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10772 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10773 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10774
10775'``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10776^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10777
10778Syntax:
10779"""""""
10780
10781This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
10782on any integer bit width.
10783
10784::
10785
10786 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10787 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10788 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10789
10790Overview:
10791"""""""""
10792
10793The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10794an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10795overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
10796
10797Arguments:
10798""""""""""
10799
10800The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10801may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10802bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10803``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10804subtraction.
10805
10806Semantics:
10807""""""""""
10808
10809The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010810an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010811the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
10812which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
10813overflow.
10814
10815Examples:
10816"""""""""
10817
10818.. code-block:: llvm
10819
10820 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10821 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10822 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10823 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10824
10825'``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10826^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10827
10828Syntax:
10829"""""""
10830
10831This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
10832on any integer bit width.
10833
10834::
10835
10836 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10837 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10838 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10839
10840Overview:
10841"""""""""
10842
10843The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10844a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10845overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
10846
10847Arguments:
10848""""""""""
10849
10850The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10851may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10852bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10853``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10854multiplication.
10855
10856Semantics:
10857""""""""""
10858
10859The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010860a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010861the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
10862of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
10863overflow.
10864
10865Examples:
10866"""""""""
10867
10868.. code-block:: llvm
10869
10870 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10871 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10872 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10873 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10874
10875'``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10876^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10877
10878Syntax:
10879"""""""
10880
10881This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
10882on any integer bit width.
10883
10884::
10885
10886 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10887 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10888 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10889
10890Overview:
10891"""""""""
10892
10893The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10894a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10895overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
10896
10897Arguments:
10898""""""""""
10899
10900The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10901may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10902bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10903``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10904multiplication.
10905
10906Semantics:
10907""""""""""
10908
10909The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010910an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
10911the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010912element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
10913resulted in an overflow.
10914
10915Examples:
10916"""""""""
10917
10918.. code-block:: llvm
10919
10920 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10921 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10922 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10923 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10924
10925Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
10926---------------------------------
10927
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010928'``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
10929^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10930
10931Syntax:
10932"""""""
10933
10934::
10935
10936 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
10937 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
10938
10939Overview:
10940"""""""""
10941
10942The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010943encoding of a floating point number. This canonicalization is useful for
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010944implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
10945defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
10946
10947::
10948
10949 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010950 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010951 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
10952
10953This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010954conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010955according to section 6.2.
10956
10957Examples of non-canonical encodings:
10958
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010959- x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010960 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
10961- Many normal decimal floating point numbers have non-canonical alternative
10962 encodings.
10963- Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
10964 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and with be flushed to
10965 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
10966
10967Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
10968default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
10969quiet NaN result.
10970
10971This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010972that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
109731.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010974-0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
10975
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010976``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010977
10978- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
10979- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
10980 to ``(x == y)``
10981
10982Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
10983``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
10984
10985The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
10986First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010987must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010988usual methods.
10989
10990The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
10991
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010992- The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010993 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
10994- The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000010995 operations. That is, the bits of the floating point value are not examined.
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000010996
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010997'``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
10998^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10999
11000Syntax:
11001"""""""
11002
11003::
11004
11005 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11006 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11007
11008Overview:
11009"""""""""
11010
11011The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
Lang Hames045f4392013-01-17 00:00:49 +000011012expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
11013target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
11014fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
11015and add instructions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011016
11017Arguments:
11018""""""""""
11019
11020The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
11021multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
11022
11023Semantics:
11024""""""""""
11025
11026The expression:
11027
11028::
11029
11030 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
11031
11032is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
11033not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
11034code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
11035the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000011036corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
11037instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011038
11039Examples:
11040"""""""""
11041
11042.. code-block:: llvm
11043
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +000011044 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011045
11046Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics
11047----------------------------------------
11048
11049For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a
11050storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
11051but does not support computation in the format.
11052
11053This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point
11054value as an i16, then convert it to float with
11055:ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
11056then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
11057etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
11058if needed, then converted to i16 with
11059:ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
11060i16 value.
11061
11062.. _int_convert_to_fp16:
11063
11064'``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
11065^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11066
11067Syntax:
11068"""""""
11069
11070::
11071
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011072 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
11073 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011074
11075Overview:
11076"""""""""
11077
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011078The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
11079conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011080
11081Arguments:
11082""""""""""
11083
11084The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
11085converted.
11086
11087Semantics:
11088""""""""""
11089
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011090The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
11091conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The
11092return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011093
11094Examples:
11095"""""""""
11096
11097.. code-block:: llvm
11098
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011099 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011100 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
11101
11102.. _int_convert_from_fp16:
11103
11104'``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
11105^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11106
11107Syntax:
11108"""""""
11109
11110::
11111
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011112 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
11113 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011114
11115Overview:
11116"""""""""
11117
11118The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
11119conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision
11120floating point format.
11121
11122Arguments:
11123""""""""""
11124
11125The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
11126converted.
11127
11128Semantics:
11129""""""""""
11130
11131The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
11132conversion from half single precision floating point format to single
11133precision floating point format. The input half-float value is
11134represented by an ``i16`` value.
11135
11136Examples:
11137"""""""""
11138
11139.. code-block:: llvm
11140
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011141 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
Matt Arsenault3e3ddda2014-07-10 03:22:16 +000011142 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011143
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +000011144.. _dbg_intrinsics:
11145
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011146Debugger Intrinsics
11147-------------------
11148
11149The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
11150prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
11151Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_
11152document.
11153
11154Exception Handling Intrinsics
11155-----------------------------
11156
11157The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
11158``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
11159Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ document.
11160
11161.. _int_trampoline:
11162
11163Trampoline Intrinsics
11164---------------------
11165
11166These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
11167the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
11168callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
11169not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
11170in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
11171stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
11172argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
11173extension.
11174
11175For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
11176then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
11177It can be created as follows:
11178
11179.. code-block:: llvm
11180
11181 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +000011182 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011183 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
11184 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
11185 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
11186
11187The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
11188``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
11189
11190.. _int_it:
11191
11192'``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
11193^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11194
11195Syntax:
11196"""""""
11197
11198::
11199
11200 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
11201
11202Overview:
11203"""""""""
11204
11205This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
11206turning it into a trampoline.
11207
11208Arguments:
11209""""""""""
11210
11211The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
11212pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
11213sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
11214intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
11215LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
11216front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
11217target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
11218bitcast to an ``i8*``.
11219
11220Semantics:
11221""""""""""
11222
11223The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
11224dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
11225passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
11226be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
11227function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
11228marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
11229argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
11230function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
11231but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
11232calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
11233modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
11234pointer is undefined.
11235
11236.. _int_at:
11237
11238'``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
11239^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11240
11241Syntax:
11242"""""""
11243
11244::
11245
11246 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
11247
11248Overview:
11249"""""""""
11250
11251This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
11252a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
11253
11254Arguments:
11255""""""""""
11256
11257``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
11258code filled in by a previous call to
11259:ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
11260
11261Semantics:
11262""""""""""
11263
11264On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000011265different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011266intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
11267after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
11268returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
11269
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011270.. _int_mload_mstore:
11271
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011272Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
11273---------------------------------------
11274
11275LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
11276
11277.. _int_mload:
11278
11279'``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
11280^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11281
11282Syntax:
11283"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011284This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011285
11286::
11287
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011288 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
11289 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
11290 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
11291 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
11292 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
11293 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011294
11295Overview:
11296"""""""""
11297
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011298Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011299
11300
11301Arguments:
11302""""""""""
11303
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011304The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011305
11306
11307Semantics:
11308""""""""""
11309
11310The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
11311The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
11312
11313
11314::
11315
11316 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000011317
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011318 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011319 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000011320 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011321
11322.. _int_mstore:
11323
11324'``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
11325^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11326
11327Syntax:
11328"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011329This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011330
11331::
11332
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011333 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
11334 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
11335 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
11336 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
11337 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
11338 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011339
11340Overview:
11341"""""""""
11342
11343Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
11344
11345Arguments:
11346""""""""""
11347
11348The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
11349
11350
11351Semantics:
11352""""""""""
11353
11354The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
11355The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
11356
11357::
11358
11359 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000011360
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000011361 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011362 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011363 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
11364 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
11365
11366
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011367Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
11368-------------------------------------------
11369
11370LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
11371
11372.. _int_mgather:
11373
11374'``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
11375^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11376
11377Syntax:
11378"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011379This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011380
11381::
11382
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011383 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
11384 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64 (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
11385 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011386
11387Overview:
11388"""""""""
11389
11390Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
11391
11392
11393Arguments:
11394""""""""""
11395
11396The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
11397
11398
11399Semantics:
11400""""""""""
11401
11402The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
11403The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
11404
11405
11406::
11407
11408 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>)
11409
11410 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
11411 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
11412 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
11413 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
11414 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
11415
11416 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
11417 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
11418 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
11419 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
11420
11421 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
11422 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
11423 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
11424 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
11425
11426.. _int_mscatter:
11427
11428'``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
11429^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11430
11431Syntax:
11432"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011433This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011434
11435::
11436
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011437 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
11438 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
11439 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011440
11441Overview:
11442"""""""""
11443
11444Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
11445
11446Arguments:
11447""""""""""
11448
11449The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
11450
11451
11452Semantics:
11453""""""""""
11454
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +000011455The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011456
11457::
11458
11459 ;; This instruction unconditionaly stores data vector in multiple addresses
11460 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
11461
11462 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
11463 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
11464 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
11465 ..
11466 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
11467 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
11468 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
11469 ..
11470 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
11471 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
11472 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
11473 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
11474 ..
11475 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
11476
11477
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011478Memory Use Markers
11479------------------
11480
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000011481This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011482memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
11483
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011484.. _int_lifestart:
11485
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011486'``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
11487^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11488
11489Syntax:
11490"""""""
11491
11492::
11493
11494 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11495
11496Overview:
11497"""""""""
11498
11499The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
11500object's lifetime.
11501
11502Arguments:
11503""""""""""
11504
11505The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11506object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11507to the object.
11508
11509Semantics:
11510""""""""""
11511
11512This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
11513of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
11514to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
11515that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
11516
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011517.. _int_lifeend:
11518
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011519'``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
11520^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11521
11522Syntax:
11523"""""""
11524
11525::
11526
11527 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11528
11529Overview:
11530"""""""""
11531
11532The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
11533object's lifetime.
11534
11535Arguments:
11536""""""""""
11537
11538The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11539object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11540to the object.
11541
11542Semantics:
11543""""""""""
11544
11545This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
11546the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
11547never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
11548object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
11549
11550'``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
11551^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11552
11553Syntax:
11554"""""""
11555
11556::
11557
11558 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11559
11560Overview:
11561"""""""""
11562
11563The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
11564a memory object will not change.
11565
11566Arguments:
11567""""""""""
11568
11569The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11570object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11571to the object.
11572
11573Semantics:
11574""""""""""
11575
11576This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
11577the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
11578unchanging.
11579
11580'``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
11581^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11582
11583Syntax:
11584"""""""
11585
11586::
11587
11588 declare void @llvm.invariant.end({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11589
11590Overview:
11591"""""""""
11592
11593The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
11594memory object are mutable.
11595
11596Arguments:
11597""""""""""
11598
11599The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
11600The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11601object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
11602pointer to the object.
11603
11604Semantics:
11605""""""""""
11606
11607This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
11608
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000011609'``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' Intrinsic
11610^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11611
11612Syntax:
11613"""""""
11614
11615::
11616
11617 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* <ptr>)
11618
11619Overview:
11620"""""""""
11621
11622The '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
11623established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
11624value that does not carry the invariant information.
11625
11626
11627Arguments:
11628""""""""""
11629
11630The ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` takes only one argument, which is
11631the pointer to the memory for which the ``invariant.group`` no longer holds.
11632
11633Semantics:
11634""""""""""
11635
11636Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
11637for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
11638
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011639General Intrinsics
11640------------------
11641
11642This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
11643purpose.
11644
11645'``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
11646^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11647
11648Syntax:
11649"""""""
11650
11651::
11652
11653 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11654
11655Overview:
11656"""""""""
11657
11658The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
11659
11660Arguments:
11661""""""""""
11662
11663The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
11664global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
11665source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
11666
11667Semantics:
11668""""""""""
11669
11670This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
11671strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
11672to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
11673ignored by code generation and optimization.
11674
Michael Gottesman88d18832013-03-26 00:34:27 +000011675'``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
11676^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11677
11678Syntax:
11679"""""""
11680
11681This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
11682pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
11683the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
11684'``0``'.
11685
11686::
11687
11688 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11689 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11690 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11691 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11692 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11693
11694Overview:
11695"""""""""
11696
11697The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
11698
11699Arguments:
11700""""""""""
11701
11702The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
11703(result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
11704third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
11705last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
11706
11707Semantics:
11708""""""""""
11709
11710This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
11711strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
11712for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
11713generation and optimization.
11714
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011715'``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
11716^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11717
11718Syntax:
11719"""""""
11720
11721This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
11722any integer bit width.
11723
11724::
11725
11726 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11727 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11728 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11729 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11730 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11731
11732Overview:
11733"""""""""
11734
11735The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
11736
11737Arguments:
11738""""""""""
11739
11740The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
11741second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
11742global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
11743the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
11744
11745Semantics:
11746""""""""""
11747
11748This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
11749with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
11750optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
11751other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
11752
11753'``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
11754^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11755
11756Syntax:
11757"""""""
11758
11759::
11760
11761 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
11762
11763Overview:
11764"""""""""
11765
11766The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
11767
11768Arguments:
11769""""""""""
11770
11771None.
11772
11773Semantics:
11774""""""""""
11775
11776This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
11777the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
11778lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
11779
11780'``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
11781^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11782
11783Syntax:
11784"""""""
11785
11786::
11787
11788 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
11789
11790Overview:
11791"""""""""
11792
11793The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
11794
11795Arguments:
11796""""""""""
11797
11798None.
11799
11800Semantics:
11801""""""""""
11802
11803This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
11804execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
11805debugger.
11806
11807'``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
11808^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11809
11810Syntax:
11811"""""""
11812
11813::
11814
11815 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
11816
11817Overview:
11818"""""""""
11819
11820The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
11821onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
11822is placed on the stack before local variables.
11823
11824Arguments:
11825""""""""""
11826
11827The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
11828The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
11829``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
11830enough space to hold the value of the guard.
11831
11832Semantics:
11833""""""""""
11834
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011835This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
11836the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
11837to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
11838the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
11839checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
11840different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
11841calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11842
11843'``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``' Intrinsic
Sean Silva9d1e1a32013-09-09 19:13:28 +000011844^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011845
11846Syntax:
11847"""""""
11848
11849::
11850
11851 declare void @llvm.stackprotectorcheck(i8** <guard>)
11852
11853Overview:
11854"""""""""
11855
11856The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic compares ``guard`` against an already
Michael Gottesman98850bd2013-08-12 19:44:09 +000011857created stack protector and if they are not equal calls the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011858``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11859
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011860Arguments:
11861""""""""""
11862
11863The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic requires one pointer argument, the
11864the variable ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
11865
11866Semantics:
11867""""""""""
11868
11869This intrinsic is provided to perform the stack protector check by comparing
11870``guard`` with the stack slot created by ``llvm.stackprotector`` and if the
11871values do not match call the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11872
11873The reason to provide this as an IR level intrinsic instead of implementing it
11874via other IR operations is that in order to perform this operation at the IR
11875level without an intrinsic, one would need to create additional basic blocks to
11876handle the success/failure cases. This makes it difficult to stop the stack
11877protector check from disrupting sibling tail calls in Codegen. With this
11878intrinsic, we are able to generate the stack protector basic blocks late in
Benjamin Kramer3b32b2f2013-10-29 17:53:27 +000011879codegen after the tail call decision has occurred.
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011880
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011881'``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
11882^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11883
11884Syntax:
11885"""""""
11886
11887::
11888
11889 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
11890 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
11891
11892Overview:
11893"""""""""
11894
11895The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
11896the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
11897(like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
11898b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
11899context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
11900other object.
11901
11902Arguments:
11903""""""""""
11904
11905The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first
11906argument is a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument is
11907a boolean and determines whether ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true)
11908or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument
11909only accepts constants.
11910
11911Semantics:
11912""""""""""
11913
11914The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
11915the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
11916compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
11917on the ``min`` argument).
11918
11919'``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
11920^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11921
11922Syntax:
11923"""""""
11924
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000011925This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
11926integer bit width.
11927
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011928::
11929
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000011930 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011931 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
11932 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
11933
11934Overview:
11935"""""""""
11936
11937The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
11938most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
11939
11940Arguments:
11941""""""""""
11942
11943The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
11944a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
11945constant value, variables are not allowed.
11946
11947Semantics:
11948""""""""""
11949
11950This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
11951
Philip Reamese0e90832015-04-26 22:23:12 +000011952.. _int_assume:
11953
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011954'``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
11955^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11956
11957Syntax:
11958"""""""
11959
11960::
11961
11962 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
11963
11964Overview:
11965"""""""""
11966
11967The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
11968condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
11969of the code.
11970
11971Arguments:
11972""""""""""
11973
11974The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
11975
11976Semantics:
11977""""""""""
11978
11979The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
11980always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
11981generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
11982provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
11983violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
11984
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000011985Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011986used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
11987only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000011988if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011989sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
11990``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
11991that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
11992optimizer.
11993
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000011994.. _bitset.test:
11995
11996'``llvm.bitset.test``' Intrinsic
11997^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11998
11999Syntax:
12000"""""""
12001
12002::
12003
12004 declare i1 @llvm.bitset.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %bitset) nounwind readnone
12005
12006
12007Arguments:
12008""""""""""
12009
12010The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
Peter Collingbourne8d24ae92015-09-08 22:49:35 +000012011metadata object representing an identifier for a :doc:`bitset <BitSets>`.
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012012
12013Overview:
12014"""""""""
12015
12016The ``llvm.bitset.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is a
12017member of the given bitset.
12018
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012019'``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
12020^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12021
12022Syntax:
12023"""""""
12024
12025::
12026
12027 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
12028
12029Overview:
12030"""""""""
12031
Juergen Ributzkac9161192014-10-23 22:36:13 +000012032The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
12033two intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint``) that can be called
12034with an invoke instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012035
12036Arguments:
12037""""""""""
12038
12039None.
12040
12041Semantics:
12042""""""""""
12043
12044This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
12045by codegen.
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000012046
12047Stack Map Intrinsics
12048--------------------
12049
12050LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
12051mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
12052are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.